summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/digital
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorNicolas Schodet2009-04-10 01:15:42 +0200
committerNicolas Schodet2009-04-10 01:15:42 +0200
commit74298f8ca11dc8d3b0359d1d4e124d6494c3eeac (patch)
tree4c3d2147b99686805d8654dd9552191eab080f1a /digital
parent1431438a2b0f3fafbafb61a4a15296164dadf5e1 (diff)
* digital/avr/modules/usb:
- imported LUFA.
Diffstat (limited to 'digital')
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c570
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h135
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt40
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c247
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h95
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf55
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile707
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c692
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h199
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt52
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c181
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h166
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile710
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c218
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h91
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c156
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h73
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt41
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile707
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile29
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.c231
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.h90
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt48
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.c314
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.h322
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c305
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h127
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.txt50
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/Descriptors.c314
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/Descriptors.h322
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/CDC.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/CDC.c318
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/CDC.h190
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/CDC.txt45
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/Descriptors.c263
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/Descriptors.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/LUFA CDC.inf55
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDC/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/CDCHost.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/CDCHost.c278
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/CDCHost.h89
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/CDCHost.txt42
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/ConfigDescriptor.c212
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/ConfigDescriptor.h86
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/CDCHost/makefile705
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/Descriptors.c385
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/Descriptors.h118
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/DualCDC.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/DualCDC.c358
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/DualCDC.h126
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/DualCDC.txt57
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/LUFA DualCDC.inf56
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/DualCDC/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/Descriptors.c250
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/Descriptors.h93
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/Joystick.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/Joystick.c264
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/Joystick.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/Joystick.txt44
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Joystick/makefile700
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/Descriptors.c267
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/Descriptors.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/Keyboard.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/Keyboard.c429
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/Keyboard.h116
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/Keyboard.txt43
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Keyboard/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/Descriptors.c267
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/Descriptors.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/KeyboardFullInt.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/KeyboardFullInt.c462
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/KeyboardFullInt.h115
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/KeyboardFullInt.txt44
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardFullInt/makefile701
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.c144
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/ConfigDescriptor.h74
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.c314
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.h95
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/KeyboardHost.txt46
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHost/makefile705
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/ConfigDescriptor.c149
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/ConfigDescriptor.h74
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/KeyboardHostViaInt.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/KeyboardHostViaInt.c321
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/KeyboardHostViaInt.h95
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/KeyboardHostViaInt.txt47
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostViaInt/makefile705
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c171
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h81
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.c119
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/HIDReport.h80
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.c345
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.h80
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/KeyboardHostWithParser.txt44
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardHostWithParser/makefile707
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.c354
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/Descriptors.h104
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.c372
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.h114
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/KeyboardMouse.txt48
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardMouse/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/Descriptors.c267
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/Descriptors.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/KeyboardViaInt.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/KeyboardViaInt.c453
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/KeyboardViaInt.h112
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/KeyboardViaInt.txt44
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/KeyboardViaInt/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/Descriptors.c325
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/Descriptors.h189
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/MIDI.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/MIDI.c225
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/MIDI.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/MIDI.txt48
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MIDI/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/DataflashManager.c316
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/DataflashManager.h71
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/Descriptors.c223
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/Descriptors.h71
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/MassStorage.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/MassStorage.c396
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/MassStorage.h159
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/MassStorage.txt54
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/SCSI.c350
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/SCSI.h143
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/SCSI_Codes.h85
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorage/makefile704
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c173
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h77
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.c420
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.h85
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/MassStorageHost.txt43
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/MassStoreCommands.c664
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/MassStoreCommands.h176
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/SCSI_Codes.h85
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MassStorageHost/makefile706
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/Descriptors.c251
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/Descriptors.h93
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/Mouse.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/Mouse.c376
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/Mouse.h115
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/Mouse.txt43
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/Mouse/makefile703
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/Descriptors.c250
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/Descriptors.h93
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/MouseFullInt.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/MouseFullInt.c399
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/MouseFullInt.h114
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/MouseFullInt.txt44
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseFullInt/makefile703
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.c155
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/ConfigDescriptor.h74
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/MouseHost.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/MouseHost.c310
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/MouseHost.h95
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/MouseHost.txt47
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHost/makefile705
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/ConfigDescriptor.c149
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/ConfigDescriptor.h74
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/MouseHostViaInt.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/MouseHostViaInt.c320
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/MouseHostViaInt.h96
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/MouseHostViaInt.txt48
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostViaInt/makefile705
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.c171
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/ConfigDescriptor.h82
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.c119
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/HIDReport.h89
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.c352
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.h80
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/MouseHostWithParser.txt44
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseHostWithParser/makefile707
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/Descriptors.c250
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/Descriptors.h93
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/MouseViaInt.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/MouseViaInt.c389
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/MouseViaInt.h111
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/MouseViaInt.txt44
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/MouseViaInt/makefile703
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/ARP.c85
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/ARP.h76
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/DHCP.c118
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/DHCP.h125
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.c263
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/Descriptors.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/Ethernet.c136
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/Ethernet.h116
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/EthernetProtocols.h87
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/ICMP.c79
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/ICMP.h80
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/IP.c111
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/IP.h93
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/LUFA RNDIS.inf52
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/ProtocolDecoders.c280
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/ProtocolDecoders.h56
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/RNDIS.c386
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/RNDIS.h226
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/RNDISConstants.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.c357
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.h108
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/RNDISEthernet.txt62
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/TCP.c614
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/TCP.h253
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/UDP.c80
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/UDP.h66
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/Webserver.c162
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/Webserver.h55
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/RNDISEthernet/makefile715
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.c191
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/ConfigDescriptor.h77
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/PIMACodes.h51
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/StillImageCommands.c273
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/StillImageCommands.h102
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.c436
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.h83
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/StillImageHost.txt40
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/StillImageHost/makefile705
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/Descriptors.c187
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/Descriptors.h59
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/TestApp.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/TestApp.c198
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/TestApp.h62
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/TestApp.txt51
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/TestEvents.c226
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/TestEvents.h110
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/TestApp/makefile710
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.c263
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/Descriptors.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/LUFA USBtoSerial.inf55
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/RingBuff.c120
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/RingBuff.h116
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.c390
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.h192
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/USBtoSerial.txt45
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/USBtoSerial/makefile704
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/makefile121
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA.pnproj1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/BuildingLinkableLibraries.txt22
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/ChangeLog.txt387
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Common/BoardTypes.h72
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Common/ButtLoadTag.h77
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Common/Common.h171
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Common/FunctionAttributes.h110
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/CompileTimeTokens.txt167
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/DirectorySummaries.txt119
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/DriverStubs/Dataflash.h81
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/DriverStubs/HWB.h84
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/DriverStubs/Joystick.h99
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/DriverStubs/LEDs.h121
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/ADC.h58
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/AT90USBXXX67/ADC.h177
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/SPI.h139
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/Serial.c65
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/Serial.h115
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/Serial_Stream.c45
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/Serial_Stream.h82
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/ATAVRUSBRF01/HWB.h79
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/ATAVRUSBRF01/LEDs.h120
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h210
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/HWB.h87
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Joystick.h85
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h113
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/RZUSBSTICK/LEDs.h141
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK525/AT45DB321C.h84
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK525/Dataflash.h75
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK525/HWB.h79
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK525/Joystick.h104
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK525/LEDs.h117
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK526/AT45DB642D.h94
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK526/Dataflash.h75
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK526/HWB.h79
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK526/Joystick.h101
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/STK526/LEDs.h117
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.c60
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/Temperature.h100
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/USBKEY/AT45DB642D.h94
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/USBKEY/Dataflash.h78
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/USBKEY/HWB.h79
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/USBKEY/Joystick.h104
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Board/USBKEY/LEDs.h117
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/Misc/TerminalCodes.h176
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/ConfigDescriptor.c135
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/ConfigDescriptor.h258
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/HIDParser.c326
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/HIDParser.h252
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/Class/HIDReportData.h128
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c39
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.h440
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c43
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.h523
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c252
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.h224
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c257
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.h198
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c313
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.h135
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Device.h126
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c387
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.h842
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Host.c115
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Host.h245
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/HostChapter9.c175
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/HostChapter9.h127
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c260
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.h371
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/OTG.h102
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Pipe.c258
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Pipe.h788
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/StdRequestType.h191
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/StreamCallbacks.h87
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/USBMode.h77
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h83
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/GettingStarted.txt117
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/MainPage.txt75
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/MemoryAllocator/DynAlloc.c226
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/MemoryAllocator/DynAlloc.h182
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/MigrationInformation.txt227
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Scheduler/Scheduler.c95
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Scheduler/Scheduler.h262
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/SchedulerOverview.txt31
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/VIDAndPIDValues.txt224
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/Version.h49
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/WritingBoardDrivers.txt26
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/LUFA/makefile42
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/AVRISP_Firmware_Design.txt176
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/AVRISP_Programmer.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/AVRISP_Programmer.c886
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/AVRISP_Programmer.h194
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/AVRISP_Programmer.txt89
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/AVRISP_Programmer_Picture.jpgbin0 -> 74610 bytes
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/Descriptors.c263
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/Descriptors.h98
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/LUFA AVRISP_Programmer.inf55
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/RingBuff.c120
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/RingBuff.h116
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/Sample_Programming_Session.txt104
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/AVRISP_Programmer/makefile702
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/CircularBitBuffer.c113
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/CircularBitBuffer.h90
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.c247
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Descriptors.h99
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Doxygen.conf1485
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.aps1
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.c436
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.h121
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/Magstripe.txt85
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/MagstripeHW.h100
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/Magstripe/makefile710
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Projects/makefile25
-rw-r--r--digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/makefile27
395 files changed, 119098 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a0f0e756
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.aps
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>BootloaderCDC</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:09</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:20:30</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:09</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile>BootloaderCDC.elf</ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM>Auto</COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>BootloaderCDC.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>BootloaderCDC.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>BootloaderCDC.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><ProjectFiles><Files><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\BootloaderCDC.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\Descriptors.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\BootloaderCDC.c</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\CDC\Descriptors.c</Name></Files></ProjectFiles><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..654eabd2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.c
@@ -0,0 +1,570 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Main source file for the CDC class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
+ */
+
+#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C
+#include "BootloaderCDC.h"
+
+/* Globals: */
+/** Line coding options for the virtual serial port. Although the virtual serial port data is never
+ * sent through a physical serial port, the line encoding data must still be read and preserved from
+ * the host, or the host will detect a problem and fail to open the port. This structure contains the
+ * current encoding options, including baud rate, character format, parity mode and total number of
+ * bits in each data chunk.
+ */
+CDC_Line_Coding_t LineCoding = { BaudRateBPS: 9600,
+ CharFormat: OneStopBit,
+ ParityType: Parity_None,
+ DataBits: 8 };
+
+/** Current address counter. This stores the current address of the FLASH or EEPROM as set by the host,
+ * and is used when reading or writing to the AVRs memory (either FLASH or EEPROM depending on the issued
+ * command.)
+ */
+uint16_t CurrAddress;
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
+ * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
+ * jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000.
+ */
+bool RunBootloader = true;
+
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously
+ * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start
+ * the loaded application code.
+ */
+int main(void)
+{
+ /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+ MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+ wdt_disable();
+
+ /* Disable Clock Division */
+ SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+
+ /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
+
+ /* Initialize USB Subsystem */
+ USB_Init();
+
+ while (RunBootloader)
+ {
+ USB_USBTask();
+ CDC_Task();
+ }
+
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
+
+ /* Wait until any pending transmissions have completed before shutting down */
+ while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+
+ /* Shut down the USB subsystem */
+ USB_ShutDown();
+
+ /* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+ MCUCR = 0;
+
+ /* Reset any used hardware ports back to their defaults */
+ PORTD = 0;
+ DDRD = 0;
+
+ #if defined(PORTE)
+ PORTE = 0;
+ DDRE = 0;
+ #endif
+
+ /* Re-enable RWW section */
+ boot_rww_enable();
+
+ /* Start the user application */
+ AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000;
+ AppStartPtr();
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the bootloader should exit and the user
+ * application started.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
+{
+ /* Upon disconnection, run user application */
+ RunBootloader = false;
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready
+ * to relay data to and from the attached USB host.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
+{
+ /* Setup CDC Notification, Rx and Tx Endpoints */
+ Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+ ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE,
+ ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+
+ Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_BULK,
+ ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+ ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+
+ Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_BULK,
+ ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT, CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+ ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ * control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library, so that they can be handled appropriately
+ * for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+ uint8_t* LineCodingData = (uint8_t*)&LineCoding;
+
+ Endpoint_Discard_Word();
+
+ /* Process CDC specific control requests */
+ switch (bRequest)
+ {
+ case REQ_GetLineEncoding:
+ if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_DEVICETOHOST | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ for (uint8_t i = 0; i < sizeof(LineCoding); i++)
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(*(LineCodingData++));
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+ }
+
+ break;
+ case REQ_SetLineEncoding:
+ if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+
+ for (uint8_t i = 0; i < sizeof(LineCoding); i++)
+ *(LineCodingData++) = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+ }
+
+ break;
+ case REQ_SetControlLineState:
+ if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+ }
+
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/** Reads or writes a block of EEPROM or FLASH memory to or from the appropriate CDC data endpoint, depending
+ * on the AVR910 protocol command issued.
+ *
+ * \param Command Single character AVR910 protocol command indicating what memory operation to perform
+ */
+static void ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command)
+{
+ uint16_t BlockSize;
+ char MemoryType;
+
+ bool HighByte = false;
+ uint8_t LowByte = 0;
+
+ BlockSize = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8);
+ BlockSize |= FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+ MemoryType = FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+ if ((MemoryType == 'E') || (MemoryType == 'F'))
+ {
+ /* Check if command is to read memory */
+ if (Command == 'g')
+ {
+ /* Re-enable RWW section */
+ boot_rww_enable();
+
+ while (BlockSize--)
+ {
+ if (MemoryType == 'E')
+ {
+ /* Read the next EEPROM byte into the endpoint */
+ WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress));
+
+ /* Increment the address counter after use */
+ CurrAddress++;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Read the next FLASH byte from the current FLASH page */
+ #if defined(RAMPZ)
+ WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte_far(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1) + HighByte));
+ #else
+ WriteNextResponseByte(pgm_read_byte((CurrAddress << 1) + HighByte));
+ #endif
+
+ /* If both bytes in current word have been read, increment the address counter */
+ if (HighByte)
+ CurrAddress++;
+
+ HighByte ^= 1;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ uint32_t PageStartAddress = ((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1);
+
+ if (MemoryType == 'F')
+ {
+ boot_page_erase(PageStartAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+ }
+
+ while (BlockSize--)
+ {
+ if (MemoryType == 'E')
+ {
+ /* Write the next EEPROM byte from the endpoint */
+ eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte());
+
+ /* Increment the address counter after use */
+ CurrAddress++;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* If both bytes in current word have been written, increment the address counter */
+ if (HighByte)
+ {
+ /* Write the next FLASH word to the current FLASH page */
+ boot_page_fill(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1), ((FetchNextCommandByte() << 8) | LowByte));
+
+ HighByte = false;
+
+ /* Increment the address counter after use */
+ CurrAddress++;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ LowByte = FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+ HighByte = true;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If in FLASH programming mode, commit the page after writing */
+ if (MemoryType == 'F')
+ {
+ /* Commit the flash page to memory */
+ boot_page_write(PageStartAddress);
+
+ /* Wait until write operation has completed */
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+ }
+
+ /* Send response byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Send error byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('?');
+ }
+}
+
+/** Retrieves the next byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint, and clears the endpoint bank if needed
+ * to allow reception of the next data packet from the host.
+ *
+ * \return Next received byte from the host in the CDC data OUT endpoint
+ */
+static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void)
+{
+ /* Select the OUT endpoint so that the next data byte can be read */
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
+
+ /* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */
+ if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+ while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+ }
+
+ /* Fetch the next byte from the OUT endpoint */
+ return Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+}
+
+/** Writes the next response byte to the CDC data IN endpoint, and sends the endpoint back if needed to free up the
+ * bank when full ready for the next byte in the packet to the host.
+ *
+ * \param Response Next response byte to send to the host
+ */
+static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response)
+{
+ /* Select the IN endpoint so that the next data byte can be written */
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
+
+ /* If OUT endpoint empty, clear it and wait for the next packet from the host */
+ if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+ while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+ }
+
+ /* Write the next byte to the OUT endpoint */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(Response);
+}
+
+/** Task to read in AVR910 commands from the CDC data OUT endpoint, process them, perform the required actions
+ * and send the appropriate response back to the host.
+ */
+TASK(CDC_Task)
+{
+ /* Select the OUT endpoint */
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
+
+ /* Check if endpoint has a command in it sent from the host */
+ if (Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed())
+ {
+ /* Read in the bootloader command (first byte sent from host) */
+ uint8_t Command = FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+ if ((Command == 'L') || (Command == 'P') || (Command == 'T') || (Command == 'E'))
+ {
+ if (Command == 'E')
+ RunBootloader = false;
+ if (Command == 'T')
+ FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+ /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 't')
+ {
+ /* Return ATMEGA128 part code - this is only to allow AVRProg to use the bootloader */
+ WriteNextResponseByte(0x44);
+
+ WriteNextResponseByte(0x00);
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'a')
+ {
+ /* Indicate auto-address increment is supported */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('Y');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'A')
+ {
+ /* Set the current address to that given by the host */
+ CurrAddress = (FetchNextCommandByte() << 8);
+ CurrAddress |= FetchNextCommandByte();
+
+ /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'p')
+ {
+ /* Indicate serial programmer back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('S');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'S')
+ {
+ /* Write the 7-byte software identifier to the endpoint */
+ for (uint8_t CurrByte = 0; CurrByte < 7; CurrByte++)
+ WriteNextResponseByte(SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER[CurrByte]);
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'V')
+ {
+ WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR);
+ WriteNextResponseByte('0' + BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR);
+ }
+ else if (Command == 's')
+ {
+ WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(4));
+ WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(2));
+ WriteNextResponseByte(boot_signature_byte_get(0));
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'b')
+ {
+ WriteNextResponseByte('Y');
+
+ /* Send block size to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE >> 8);
+ WriteNextResponseByte(SPM_PAGESIZE & 0xFF);
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'e')
+ {
+ /* Clear the application section of flash */
+ for (uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0; CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR; CurrFlashAddress++)
+ {
+ boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+ boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+ CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE;
+ }
+
+ /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'l')
+ {
+ /* Set the lock bits to those given by the host */
+ boot_lock_bits_set(FetchNextCommandByte());
+
+ /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'r')
+ {
+ WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOCK_BITS));
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'F')
+ {
+ WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_LOW_FUSE_BITS));
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'N')
+ {
+ WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_HIGH_FUSE_BITS));
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'Q')
+ {
+ WriteNextResponseByte(boot_lock_fuse_bits_get(GET_EXTENDED_FUSE_BITS));
+ }
+ else if ((Command == 'C') || (Command == 'c'))
+ {
+ if (Command == 'c')
+ {
+ /* Increment the address if the second byte is being written */
+ CurrAddress++;
+ }
+
+ /* Write the high byte to the current flash page */
+ boot_page_fill(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1), FetchNextCommandByte());
+
+ /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'm')
+ {
+ /* Commit the flash page to memory */
+ boot_page_write((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1);
+
+ /* Wait until write operation has completed */
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+ /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ else if ((Command == 'B') || (Command == 'g'))
+ {
+ /* Delegate the block write/read to a seperate function for clarity */
+ ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(Command);
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'R')
+ {
+ #if defined(RAMPZ)
+ uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word_far(((uint32_t)CurrAddress << 1));
+ #else
+ uint16_t ProgramWord = pgm_read_word(CurrAddress << 1);
+ #endif
+
+ WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord >> 8);
+ WriteNextResponseByte(ProgramWord & 0xFF);
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'D')
+ {
+ /* Read the byte from the endpoint and write it to the EEPROM */
+ eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress, FetchNextCommandByte());
+
+ /* Increment the address after use */
+ CurrAddress++;
+
+ /* Send confirmation byte back to the host */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('\r');
+ }
+ else if (Command == 'd')
+ {
+ /* Read the EEPROM byte and write it to the endpoint */
+ WriteNextResponseByte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)CurrAddress));
+
+ /* Increment the address after use */
+ CurrAddress++;
+ }
+ else if (Command == 27)
+ {
+ /* Escape is sync, ignore */
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Unknown command, return fail code */
+ WriteNextResponseByte('?');
+ }
+
+ /* Select the IN endpoint */
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_TX_EPNUM);
+
+ /* Remember if the endpoint is completely full before clearing it */
+ bool IsEndpointFull = !(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed());
+
+ /* Send the endpoint data to the host */
+ Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+
+ /* If a full endpoint's worth of data was sent, we need to send an empty packet afterwards to signal end of transfer */
+ if (IsEndpointFull)
+ {
+ while (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()));
+ Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+ }
+
+ /* Select the OUT endpoint */
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(CDC_RX_EPNUM);
+
+ /* Acknowledge the command from the host */
+ Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+ }
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0d8f1e3d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.h
@@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for BootloaderCDC.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _CDC_H_
+#define _CDC_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <avr/io.h>
+ #include <avr/wdt.h>
+ #include <avr/boot.h>
+ #include <avr/eeprom.h>
+ #include <stdbool.h>
+
+ #include "Descriptors.h"
+
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> // USB Functionality
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** CDC Class Specific request to get the line encoding on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port, including the
+ * baud rate, parity, stop bits and data bits.
+ */
+ #define REQ_GetLineEncoding 0x21
+
+ /** CDC Class Specific request to set the line encoding on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port, including the
+ * baud rate, parity, stop bits and data bits.
+ */
+ #define REQ_SetLineEncoding 0x20
+
+ /** CDC Class Specific request to set the state of the serial handshake lines (such as DCD and RTS) on
+ * a CDC-ACM virtual serial port.
+ */
+ #define REQ_SetControlLineState 0x22
+
+ /** Version major of the CDC bootloader. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MAJOR 0x01
+
+ /** Version minor of the CDC bootloader. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 0x00
+
+ /** Hardware version major of the CDC bootloader. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MAJOR 0x01
+
+ /** Hardware version minor of the CDC bootloader. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_HWVERSION_MINOR 0x00
+
+ /** Eight character bootloader firmware identifier reported to the host when requested */
+ #define SOFTWARE_IDENTIFIER "LUFA-CDC"
+
+ /* Event Handlers: */
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_ConfigurationChanged event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_ConfigurationChanged);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
+
+ /* Type Defines: */
+ /** Type define for a non-returning pointer to the start of the loaded application in flash memory. */
+ typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN;
+
+ /** Type define for the CDC-ACM virtual serial port line encoding options, including baud rate, format, parity
+ * and size of each data chunk in bits.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ uint32_t BaudRateBPS; /**< Baud rate in BPS */
+ uint8_t CharFormat; /**< Character format, an entry from the BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodingFormats_t enum */
+ uint8_t ParityType; /**< Parity mode, an entry from the BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodeingParity_t enum */
+ uint8_t DataBits; /**< Size of each data chunk, in bits */
+ } CDC_Line_Coding_t;
+
+ /* Enums: */
+ /** Enum for the possible line encoding formats on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port */
+ enum BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodingFormats_t
+ {
+ OneStopBit = 0, /**< Single stop bit */
+ OneAndAHalfStopBits = 1, /**< 1.5 stop bits */
+ TwoStopBits = 2, /**< Two stop bits */
+ };
+
+ /** Enum for the possible parity modes on a CDC-ACM virtual serial port */
+ enum BootloaderCDC_CDC_LineCodeingParity_t
+ {
+ Parity_None = 0, /**< No data parity checking */
+ Parity_Odd = 1, /**< Odd data parity checking */
+ Parity_Even = 2, /**< Even data parity checking */
+ Parity_Mark = 3, /**< Mark data parity checking */
+ Parity_Space = 4, /**< Space data parity checking */
+ };
+
+ /* Tasks: */
+ TASK(CDC_Task);
+
+ /* Function Prototypes: */
+ #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADERCDC_C) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)
+ static void ProgramReadWriteMemoryBlock(const uint8_t Command);
+ static uint8_t FetchNextCommandByte(void);
+ static void WriteNextResponseByte(const uint8_t Response);
+ #endif
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..cb6f9f01
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/BootloaderCDC.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
+/** \file
+ *
+ * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ * documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+
+/** \mainpage CDC Class USB AVR Bootloader
+ *
+ * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a CDC Class device (virtual serial port), allowing for AVR109
+ * protocol compatible programming software to load firmware onto the AVR.
+ *
+ * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB1287, and will fit into 4KB of bootloader space. If
+ * you wish to enlarge this space and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the BOOT_START and MCU
+ * values in the accompanying makefile.
+ *
+ * This bootloader is compatible with the open source application AVRDUDE, or Atmel's AVRPROG.
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
+ * <td>Device</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
+ * <td>Communications Device Class (CDC)</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
+ * <td>Abstract Control Model (ACM)</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
+ * <td>USBIF CDC Class Standard</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
+ * <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ee0e194d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.c
@@ -0,0 +1,247 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special
+ * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
+ * the device's capabilities and functions.
+ */
+
+#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the overall
+ * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
+ * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
+ * process begins.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
+{
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
+
+ USBSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.10),
+ Class: 0x02,
+ SubClass: 0x00,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ Endpoint0Size: FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE,
+
+ VendorID: 0x03EB,
+ ProductID: 0x204A,
+ ReleaseNumber: 0x0000,
+
+ ManufacturerStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+ ProductStrIndex: 0x01,
+ SerialNumStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ NumberOfConfigurations: 1
+};
+
+/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, describes the usage
+ * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
+ * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
+ * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
+{
+ Config:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
+
+ TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
+ TotalInterfaces: 2,
+
+ ConfigurationNumber: 1,
+ ConfigurationStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ ConfigAttributes: (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
+
+ MaxPowerConsumption: USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
+ },
+
+ CCI_Interface:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+ InterfaceNumber: 0,
+ AlternateSetting: 0,
+
+ TotalEndpoints: 1,
+
+ Class: 0x02,
+ SubClass: 0x02,
+ Protocol: 0x01,
+
+ InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ CDC_Functional_IntHeader:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
+ SubType: 0x00,
+
+ Data: {0x10, 0x01}
+ },
+
+ CDC_Functional_CallManagement:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
+ SubType: 0x01,
+
+ Data: {0x03, 0x01}
+ },
+
+ CDC_Functional_AbstractControlManagement:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(1)), Type: 0x24},
+ SubType: 0x02,
+
+ Data: {0x06}
+ },
+
+ CDC_Functional_Union:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2)), Type: 0x24},
+ SubType: 0x06,
+
+ Data: {0x00, 0x01}
+ },
+
+ ManagementEndpoint:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+
+ EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM),
+ Attributes: EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+ EndpointSize: CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE,
+ PollingIntervalMS: 0x02
+ },
+
+ DCI_Interface:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+ InterfaceNumber: 1,
+ AlternateSetting: 0,
+
+ TotalEndpoints: 2,
+
+ Class: 0x0A,
+ SubClass: 0x00,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ DataOutEndpoint:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+
+ EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_OUT | CDC_RX_EPNUM),
+ Attributes: EP_TYPE_BULK,
+ EndpointSize: CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+ PollingIntervalMS: 0x00
+ },
+
+ DataInEndpoint:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+
+ EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | CDC_TX_EPNUM),
+ Attributes: EP_TYPE_BULK,
+ EndpointSize: CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE,
+ PollingIntervalMS: 0x00
+ }
+};
+
+/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in SRAM memory, is returned when the host requests
+ * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
+ * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
+};
+
+/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
+ * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ * Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(15), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: L"AVR CDC Bootloader"
+};
+
+/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
+ * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
+ * to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
+ * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
+ * USB host.
+ */
+uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+{
+ const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8);
+ const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
+
+ void* Address = NULL;
+ uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
+
+ switch (DescriptorType)
+ {
+ case DTYPE_Device:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_Configuration:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_String:
+ if (!(DescriptorNumber))
+ {
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
+ Size = LanguageString.Header.Size;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
+ Size = ProductString.Header.Size;
+ }
+
+ break;
+ }
+
+ *DescriptorAddress = Address;
+ return Size;
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8bd6bdf8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Descriptors.h
@@ -0,0 +1,95 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for Descriptors.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** Structure for a CDC class Functional descriptor, with a given data size. This is used instead of a
+ * type define so that the same macro can be used for functional descriptors of varying data lengths,
+ * while allowing the sizeof() operator to return correct results.
+ *
+ * \param DataSize Size of the functional descriptor's data payload, in bytes
+ */
+ #define CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(DataSize) \
+ struct \
+ { \
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; \
+ uint8_t SubType; \
+ uint8_t Data[DataSize]; \
+ }
+
+ /** Endpoint number for the CDC control interface event notification endpoint. */
+ #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPNUM 3
+
+ /** Size of the CDC control interface notification endpoint bank, in bytes */
+ #define CDC_NOTIFICATION_EPSIZE 8
+
+ /** Endpoint number for the CDC data interface TX (data IN) endpoint */
+ #define CDC_TX_EPNUM 1
+
+ /** Endpoint number for the CDC data interface RX (data OUT) endpoint */
+ #define CDC_RX_EPNUM 2
+
+ /** Size of the CDC data interface TX and RX data endpoint banks, in bytes */
+ #define CDC_TXRX_EPSIZE 16
+
+ /* Type Defines: */
+ /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
+ * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
+ * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
+ USB_Descriptor_Interface_t CCI_Interface;
+ CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2) CDC_Functional_IntHeader;
+ CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2) CDC_Functional_CallManagement;
+ CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(1) CDC_Functional_AbstractControlManagement;
+ CDC_FUNCTIONAL_DESCRIPTOR(2) CDC_Functional_Union;
+ USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t ManagementEndpoint;
+ USB_Descriptor_Interface_t DCI_Interface;
+ USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t DataOutEndpoint;
+ USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t DataInEndpoint;
+ } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
+
+ /* Function Prototypes: */
+ uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+ ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..5ba226d2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/Doxygen.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
+# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
+
+# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
+# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
+#
+# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
+# The format is:
+# TAG = value [value, ...]
+# For lists items can also be appended using:
+# TAG += value [value, ...]
+# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Project related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file
+# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all
+# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the
+# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
+
+DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded
+# by quotes) that should identify the project.
+
+PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - CDC Class Bootloader"
+
+# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number.
+# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or
+# if some version control system is used.
+
+PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.0.0
+
+# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute)
+# base path where the generated documentation will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location
+# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
+
+OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/
+
+# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create
+# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output
+# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories.
+# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of
+# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would
+# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
+
+CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
+
+# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all
+# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this
+# information to generate all constant output in the proper language.
+# The default language is English, other supported languages are:
+# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional,
+# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek,
+# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages),
+# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish,
+# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene,
+# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
+
+OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
+
+# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in
+# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc).
+# Set to NO to disable this.
+
+BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
+
+# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend
+# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description.
+# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the
+# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
+
+REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
+
+# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator
+# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string
+# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be
+# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is
+# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is.
+# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically
+# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget"
+# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains"
+# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
+
+ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
+ "The $name widget" \
+ "The $name file" \
+ is \
+ provides \
+ specifies \
+ contains \
+ represents \
+ a \
+ an \
+ the
+
+# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then
+# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief
+# description.
+
+ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
+
+# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all
+# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those
+# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment
+# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
+
+INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full
+# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set
+# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
+
+FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag
+# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is
+# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of
+# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list.
+# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the
+# path to strip.
+
+STRIP_FROM_PATH =
+
+# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of
+# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells
+# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class.
+# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class
+# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that
+# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
+
+STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
+
+# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter
+# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems
+# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
+
+SHORT_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen
+# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc
+# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments
+# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
+
+JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will
+# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments
+# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring
+# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
+
+QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen
+# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or ///
+# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour.
+# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed
+# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
+
+MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
+
+# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented
+# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it
+# re-implements.
+
+INHERIT_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce
+# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will
+# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
+
+SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
+
+# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab.
+# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
+
+TAB_SIZE = 4
+
+# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts
+# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value".
+# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to
+# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which
+# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:".
+# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
+
+ALIASES =
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C.
+# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list
+# of all members will be omitted, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified
+# scopes will look different, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Fortran.
+
+OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL
+# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for
+# VHDL.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
+
+# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want
+# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should
+# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and
+# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s.
+# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration
+# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
+
+BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
+# enable parsing support.
+
+CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only.
+# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public
+# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
+
+SIP_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter
+# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default)
+# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the
+# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or
+# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the
+# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
+
+IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES
+
+# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC
+# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first
+# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default
+# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
+
+DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
+
+# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of
+# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a
+# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to
+# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using
+# the \nosubgrouping command.
+
+SUBGROUPING = YES
+
+# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum
+# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So
+# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct
+# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file,
+# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically
+# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound
+# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
+
+TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
+
+# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to
+# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
+# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
+# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is
+# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause
+# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time
+# causing a significant performance penality.
+# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the
+# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on
+# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the
+# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula:
+# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0,
+# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
+
+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE = 0
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Build related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in
+# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available.
+# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless
+# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
+
+EXTRACT_ALL = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs)
+# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES
+
+# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local
+# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in
+# the interface are included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO
+
+# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be
+# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called
+# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base
+# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default
+# anonymous namespace are hidden.
+
+EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces.
+# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the
+# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated.
+# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy.
+# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various
+# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# friend (class|struct|union) declarations.
+# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the
+# documentation.
+
+HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any
+# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function.
+# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the
+# function's detailed documentation block.
+
+HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
+
+# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation
+# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set
+# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded.
+# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
+
+INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate
+# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also
+# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ
+# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows
+# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
+
+CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen
+# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the
+# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
+
+HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation
+# of that file.
+
+SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
+
+# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline]
+# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
+
+INLINE_INFO = YES
+
+# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen
+# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members
+# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically
+# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default)
+# the group names will appear in their defined order.
+
+SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be
+# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to
+# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name,
+# not including the namespace part.
+# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
+# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the
+# alphabetical list.
+
+SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting
+# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
+
+# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional
+# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
+
+ENABLED_SECTIONS =
+
+# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines
+# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in
+# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified
+# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely.
+# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the
+# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer
+# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
+
+MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
+
+# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated
+# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the
+# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
+
+SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
+
+# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories
+# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy
+# in the documentation. The default is NO.
+
+SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
+# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the
+# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_FILES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the
+# Namespaces page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
+# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES
+
+# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that
+# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from
+# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via
+# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of
+# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file
+# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output
+# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
+
+FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
+
+# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by
+# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files
+# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents
+# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a
+# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name
+# of the layout file.
+
+LAYOUT_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated
+# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+QUIET = YES
+
+# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are
+# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank
+# NO is used.
+
+WARNINGS = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings
+# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will
+# automatically be disabled.
+
+WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for
+# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some
+# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that
+# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
+
+WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
+
+# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for
+# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters
+# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about
+# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of
+# documentation.
+
+WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES
+
+# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that
+# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text
+# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the
+# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain
+# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could
+# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
+
+WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
+
+# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning
+# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written
+# to stderr.
+
+WARN_LOGFILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the input files
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain
+# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or
+# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories
+# with spaces.
+
+INPUT = ./
+
+# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files
+# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is
+# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built
+# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for
+# the list of possible encodings.
+
+INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank the following patterns are tested:
+# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx
+# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
+
+FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \
+ *.c \
+ *.txt
+
+# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories
+# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO.
+# If left blank NO is used.
+
+RECURSIVE = YES
+
+# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should
+# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a
+# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
+
+EXCLUDE =
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or
+# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded
+# from the input.
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude
+# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched
+# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories
+# for example use the pattern */test/*
+
+EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names
+# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the
+# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the
+# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass,
+# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __*
+
+# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see
+# the \include command).
+
+EXAMPLE_PATH =
+
+# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank all files are included.
+
+EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
+
+# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be
+# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude
+# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag.
+# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
+
+# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see
+# the \image command).
+
+IMAGE_PATH =
+
+# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should
+# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program
+# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter>
+# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an
+# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes
+# to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be
+# ignored.
+
+INPUT_FILTER =
+
+# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern
+# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the
+# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form:
+# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further
+# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER
+# is applied to all files.
+
+FILTER_PATTERNS =
+
+# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using
+# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source
+# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
+
+FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to source browsing
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will
+# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources.
+# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also
+# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
+
+SOURCE_BROWSER = NO
+
+# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body
+# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
+
+INLINE_SOURCES = NO
+
+# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct
+# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code
+# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
+
+STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
+
+# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented
+# functions referencing it will be listed.
+
+REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented entities
+# called/used by that function will be listed.
+
+REFERENCES_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
+# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
+# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
+# link to the source code. Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
+
+REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
+
+# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code
+# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen
+# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source
+# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You
+# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
+
+USE_HTAGS = NO
+
+# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for
+# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
+
+VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index
+# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project
+# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
+
+ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
+
+# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then
+# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns
+# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
+
+COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
+
+# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all
+# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index.
+# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that
+# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
+
+IGNORE_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the HTML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate HTML output.
+
+GENERATE_HTML = YES
+
+# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
+
+HTML_OUTPUT = html
+
+# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for
+# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank
+# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
+
+HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
+
+# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header.
+
+HTML_HEADER =
+
+# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard footer.
+
+HTML_FOOTER =
+
+# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading
+# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to
+# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen
+# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy
+# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own
+# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
+
+HTML_STYLESHEET =
+
+# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes,
+# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to
+# NO a bullet list will be used.
+
+HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
+
+# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML
+# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the
+# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
+
+HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3
+# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard).
+# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the
+# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that
+# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in
+# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find
+# it at startup.
+# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
+
+GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the
+# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple
+# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite)
+# can be grouped.
+
+DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that
+# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a
+# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen
+# will append .docset to the name.
+
+DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the
+# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm)
+# of the generated HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You
+# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be
+# written to the html output directory.
+
+CHM_FILE =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of
+# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run
+# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
+
+HHC_LOCATION =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag
+# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that
+# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
+
+GENERATE_CHI = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
+# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
+# content.
+
+CHM_INDEX_ENCODING =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag
+# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a
+# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
+
+BINARY_TOC = NO
+
+# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members
+# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
+
+TOC_EXPAND = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER
+# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for
+# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated
+# HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_QHP = NO
+
+# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file.
+# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
+
+QCH_FILE =
+
+# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
+
+QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
+
+QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator.
+# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated
+# .qhp file .
+
+QHG_LOCATION =
+
+# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at
+# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and
+# the value YES disables it.
+
+DISABLE_INDEX = NO
+
+# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20])
+# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
+
+ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1
+
+# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
+# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
+# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
+# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that
+# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+,
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are
+# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values
+# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
+# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
+# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
+# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
+# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
+# respectively.
+
+GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
+
+# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be
+# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree
+# is shown.
+
+TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
+
+# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included
+# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that
+# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need
+# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory
+# to force them to be regenerated.
+
+FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate Latex output.
+
+GENERATE_LATEX = NO
+
+# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
+
+LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
+
+# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be
+# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
+
+LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
+
+# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to
+# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the
+# default command name.
+
+MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
+
+# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_LATEX = NO
+
+# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used
+# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and
+# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
+
+PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
+
+# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX
+# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
+
+EXTRA_PACKAGES =
+
+# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for
+# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until
+# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
+
+LATEX_HEADER =
+
+# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated
+# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
+
+PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
+
+# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of
+# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a
+# higher quality PDF documentation.
+
+USE_PDFLATEX = YES
+
+# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode.
+# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep
+# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help.
+# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
+
+LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
+
+# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not
+# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.)
+# in the output.
+
+LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the RTF output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output
+# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with
+# other RTF readers or editors.
+
+GENERATE_RTF = NO
+
+# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
+
+RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
+
+# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_RTF = NO
+
+# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated
+# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references.
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other
+# programs which support those fields.
+# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
+
+RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
+
+# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's
+# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide
+# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
+
+RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
+
+# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document.
+# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
+
+RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the man page output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate man pages
+
+GENERATE_MAN = NO
+
+# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
+
+MAN_OUTPUT = man
+
+# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to
+# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
+
+MAN_EXTENSION = .3
+
+# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output,
+# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity
+# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files
+# only source the real man page, but without them the man command
+# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
+
+MAN_LINKS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the XML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an XML file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation.
+
+GENERATE_XML = NO
+
+# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
+
+XML_OUTPUT = xml
+
+# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_SCHEMA =
+
+# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_DTD =
+
+# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting
+# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that
+# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
+
+XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file
+# that captures the structure of the code including all
+# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental
+# and incomplete at the moment.
+
+GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the Perl module output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation. Note that this
+# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the
+# moment.
+
+GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate
+# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able
+# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
+
+PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be
+# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful
+# if you want to understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this
+# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller
+# and Perl will parse it just the same.
+
+PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
+
+# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file
+# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX.
+# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same
+# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
+
+PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include
+# files.
+
+ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro
+# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional
+# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled
+# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
+
+MACRO_EXPANSION = YES
+
+# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES
+# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the
+# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
+
+EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES
+
+# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files
+# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
+
+SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
+
+# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by
+# the preprocessor.
+
+INCLUDE_PATH =
+
+# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard
+# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the
+# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will
+# be used.
+
+INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
+
+# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that
+# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of
+# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name
+# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are
+# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being
+# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator
+# instead of the = operator.
+
+PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then
+# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded.
+# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used.
+# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
+
+EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = BUTTLOADTAG
+
+# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then
+# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone
+# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such
+# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse
+# the parser if not removed.
+
+SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to external references
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles.
+# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation
+# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without
+# this location is as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ...
+# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ...
+# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or
+# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool
+# does not have to be run to correct the links.
+# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
+# (where the name does NOT include the path)
+# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen
+# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
+
+TAGFILES =
+
+# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create
+# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
+
+GENERATE_TAGFILE =
+
+# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed
+# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes
+# will be listed.
+
+ALLEXTERNALS = NO
+
+# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed
+# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will
+# be listed.
+
+EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
+
+# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script
+# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
+
+PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the dot tool
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base
+# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that
+# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a
+# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more
+# powerful graphs.
+
+CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO
+
+# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc
+# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see
+# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the
+# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where
+# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the
+# default search path.
+
+MSCGEN_PATH =
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide
+# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented
+# or is not a class.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
+
+# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is
+# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization
+# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section
+# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
+
+HAVE_DOT = NO
+
+# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output
+# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This
+# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need
+# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name
+# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font,
+# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the
+# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory
+# containing the font.
+
+DOT_FONTNAME = FreeSans
+
+# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs.
+# The default size is 10pt.
+
+DOT_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the
+# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a
+# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot
+# can find it using this tag.
+
+DOT_FONTPATH =
+
+# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the
+# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
+
+CLASS_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and
+# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
+
+COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
+
+GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
+
+# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and
+# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling
+# Language.
+
+UML_LOOK = NO
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the
+# relations between templates and their instances.
+
+TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT
+# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented
+# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with
+# other documented files.
+
+INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and
+# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each
+# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or
+# indirectly include this file.
+
+INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs
+# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
+
+CALL_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller
+# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
+
+CALLER_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
+
+GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
+
+# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES
+# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories
+# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
+# relations between the files in the directories.
+
+DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images
+# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
+# If left blank png will be used.
+
+DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
+
+# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be
+# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
+
+DOT_PATH = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
+
+# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the
+# \dotfile command).
+
+DOTFILE_DIRS =
+
+# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of
+# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph
+# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is
+# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the
+# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note
+# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
+
+DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15
+
+# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the
+# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable
+# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes
+# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this
+# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large
+# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
+
+MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
+
+# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent
+# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not
+# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used,
+# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of
+# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
+
+DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
+
+# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output
+# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This
+# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10)
+# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
+
+DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and
+# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
+
+GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
+
+# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate
+# the various graphs.
+
+DOT_CLEANUP = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be
+# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
+
+SEARCHENGINE = NO
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6df089ab
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/LUFA CDC Bootloader.inf
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+; Windows LUFA CDC Setup File
+; Copyright (c) 2000 Microsoft Corporation
+
+[Version]
+Signature="$Windows NT$"
+Class=Ports
+ClassGuid={4D36E978-E325-11CE-BFC1-08002BE10318}
+Provider=%COMPANY%
+LayoutFile=layout.inf
+DriverVer=06/06/2006,1.0.0.0
+
+[Manufacturer]
+%MFGNAME% = ManufName
+
+[DestinationDirs]
+DefaultDestDir=12
+
+[ManufName]
+%Modem3% = Modem3, USB\VID_03EB&PID_204A
+
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+; Windows 2000/XP Sections
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+[Modem3.nt]
+CopyFiles=USBModemCopyFileSection
+AddReg=Modem3.nt.AddReg
+
+[USBModemCopyFileSection]
+usbser.sys,,,0x20
+
+[Modem3.nt.AddReg]
+HKR,,DevLoader,,*ntkern
+HKR,,NTMPDriver,,usbser.sys
+HKR,,EnumPropPages32,,"MsPorts.dll,SerialPortPropPageProvider"
+
+[Modem3.nt.Services]
+AddService=usbser, 0x00000002, DriverService
+
+[DriverService]
+DisplayName=%SERVICE%
+ServiceType=1
+StartType=3
+ErrorControl=1
+ServiceBinary=%12%\usbser.sys
+
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+; String Definitions
+;------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+[Strings]
+COMPANY="LUFA Library"
+MFGNAME="Dean Camera"
+Modem3="USB AVR109 Bootloader"
+SERVICE="USB Virtual Serial Port CDC Driver" \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..532fc17a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/CDC/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,707 @@
+# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, Jörg Wunsch, et al.
+# >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
+#
+# Released to the Public Domain
+#
+# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
+# Peter Fleury
+# Tim Henigan
+# Colin O'Flynn
+# Reiner Patommel
+# Markus Pfaff
+# Sander Pool
+# Frederik Rouleau
+# Carlos Lamas
+# Dean Camera
+# Opendous Inc.
+#
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# On command line:
+#
+# make all = Make software.
+#
+# make clean = Clean out built project files.
+#
+# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
+#
+# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
+#
+# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
+# Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
+#
+# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
+# have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
+# have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
+# (must have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
+# (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
+# DoxyGen installed)
+#
+# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging,
+# with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
+#
+# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
+#
+# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
+# bug reports to the GCC project.
+#
+# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+# MCU name
+MCU = at90usb1287
+
+
+# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
+# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called
+# "Board" inside the application directory.
+BOARD = USBKEY
+
+
+# Processor frequency.
+# This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the
+# processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to
+# calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
+# automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
+# Typical values are:
+# F_CPU = 1000000
+# F_CPU = 1843200
+# F_CPU = 2000000
+# F_CPU = 3686400
+# F_CPU = 4000000
+# F_CPU = 7372800
+# F_CPU = 8000000
+# F_CPU = 11059200
+# F_CPU = 14745600
+# F_CPU = 16000000
+# F_CPU = 18432000
+# F_CPU = 20000000
+F_CPU = 8000000
+
+
+# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
+FORMAT = ihex
+
+
+# Target file name (without extension).
+TARGET = BootloaderCDC
+
+
+# Object files directory
+# To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
+# this an empty or blank macro!
+OBJDIR = .
+
+
+# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+SRC = $(TARGET).c \
+ Descriptors.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c \
+
+# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+CPPSRC =
+
+
+# List Assembler source files here.
+# Make them always end in a capital .S. Files ending in a lowercase .s
+# will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
+# output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
+# Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
+# it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
+# care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
+ASRC =
+
+
+# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s].
+# 0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
+# (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
+OPT = s
+
+
+# Debugging format.
+# Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
+# AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
+# AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
+DEBUG = dwarf-2
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
+
+
+# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
+# c89 = "ANSI" C
+# gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
+# c99 = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
+# gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
+CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
+
+
+# Starting byte address of the bootloader
+BOOT_START = 0x1E000
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
+CDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
+CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=8 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
+ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
+CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
+CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
+CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
+CFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
+CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
+CPPFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
+#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns: create listing
+# -gstabs: have the assembler create line number information; note that
+# for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
+# and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
+# files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
+# -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex
+# dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
+ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
+
+
+#---------------- Library Options ----------------
+# Minimalistic printf version
+PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
+
+# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
+PRINTF_LIB =
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+# Minimalistic scanf version
+SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
+
+# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
+SCANF_LIB =
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+MATH_LIB = -lm
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRALIBDIRS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# only used for heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+EXTMEMOPTS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
+# -Wl,...: tell GCC to pass this to linker.
+# -Map: create map file
+# --cref: add cross reference to map file
+LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
+LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
+LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
+LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
+#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
+
+
+
+#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
+
+# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd
+# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
+#
+# Type: avrdude -c ?
+# to get a full listing.
+#
+AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
+
+# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
+AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
+
+AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
+#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
+
+
+# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
+# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
+# see avrdude manual.
+#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
+
+# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
+# performed after programming the device.
+#AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
+
+# Increase verbosity level. Please use this when submitting bug
+# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude>
+# to submit bug reports.
+#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
+
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
+
+
+
+#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
+
+# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
+DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
+
+# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
+# DEBUG_UI = gdb
+DEBUG_UI = insight
+
+# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
+DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
+#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
+
+# GDB Init Filename.
+GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
+
+# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
+JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
+
+# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
+DEBUG_PORT = 4242
+
+# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
+# just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when
+# avarice is running on a different computer.
+DEBUG_HOST = localhost
+
+
+
+#============================================================================
+
+
+# Define programs and commands.
+SHELL = sh
+CC = avr-gcc
+OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
+OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
+SIZE = avr-size
+AR = avr-ar rcs
+NM = avr-nm
+AVRDUDE = avrdude
+REMOVE = rm -f
+REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
+COPY = cp
+WINSHELL = cmd
+
+# Define Messages
+# English
+MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
+MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
+MSG_END = -------- end --------
+MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before:
+MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
+MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
+MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
+MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
+MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
+MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
+MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
+MSG_LINKING = Linking:
+MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
+MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
+MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
+MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
+MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
+
+
+
+
+# Define all object files.
+OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+
+# Define all listing files.
+LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+
+
+# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
+GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
+
+
+# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
+# Add target processor to flags.
+ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
+
+
+
+
+
+# Default target.
+all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
+
+# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
+build: elf hex eep lss sym
+#build: lib
+
+
+elf: $(TARGET).elf
+hex: $(TARGET).hex
+eep: $(TARGET).eep
+lss: $(TARGET).lss
+sym: $(TARGET).sym
+LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
+lib: $(LIBNAME)
+
+
+
+# Eye candy.
+# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
+# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
+begin:
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
+
+end:
+ @echo $(MSG_END)
+ @echo
+
+
+# Display size of file.
+HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
+ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) --mcu=$(MCU) --format=avr $(TARGET).elf
+
+sizebefore:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+sizeafter:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+checkhooks: build
+ @echo
+ @echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
+ @$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
+ cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
+ echo "(None)"
+ @echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
+
+checklibmode:
+ @echo
+ @echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
+ @$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
+ | grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
+ || echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
+ @echo ------------------------------------
+
+# Display compiler version information.
+gccversion :
+ @$(CC) --version
+
+
+
+# Program the device.
+program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ $(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
+
+flip: $(TARGET).hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu: $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ mv $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase F memory FLASH erase F
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM
+ loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex memory FLASH loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex
+ program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
+# define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set
+# a breakpoint at main().
+gdb-config:
+ @$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT) >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
+ @echo load >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+endif
+ @echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
+ @echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
+ $(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c pause
+
+else
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
+ $(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
+endif
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+
+
+
+# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
+COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
+
+
+
+coff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+
+# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
+%.hex: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
+ $(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
+
+%.eep: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
+ -$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
+ --change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
+
+# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
+%.lss: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
+ $(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
+
+# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
+%.sym: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
+ $(NM) -n $< > $@
+
+
+
+# Create library from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.a: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
+ $(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
+
+
+# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.elf: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
+ $(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
+%.s : %.c
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
+%.s : %.cpp
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
+%.i : %.c
+ $(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Target: clean project.
+clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
+
+clean_binary:
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
+
+clean_list:
+ @echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
+ $(REMOVEDIR) .dep
+
+
+doxygen:
+ @echo Generating Project Documentation...
+ @doxygen Doxygen.conf
+ @echo Documentation Generation Complete.
+
+clean_doxygen:
+ rm -rf Documentation
+
+# Create object files directory
+$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
+
+
+# Include the dependency files.
+-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
+
+
+# Listing of phony targets.
+.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin \
+finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion \
+build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff \
+clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
+gdb-config doxygen
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4d0f40b7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.aps
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>BootloaderDFU</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:47</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:21:00</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:20:47</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile></ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Bootloaders\DFU\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM></COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>BootloaderDFU.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>BootloaderDFU.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>BootloaderDFU.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a997b207
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.c
@@ -0,0 +1,692 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Main source file for the DFU class bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
+ */
+
+/** Configuration define. Define this token to true to case the bootloader to reject all memory commands
+ * until a memory erase has been performed. When used in conjunction with the lockbits of the AVR, this
+ * can protect the AVR's firmware from being dumped from a secured AVR. When false, memory operations are
+ * allowed at any time.
+ */
+#define SECURE_MODE false
+
+#define INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C
+#include "BootloaderDFU.h"
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is currently running in secure mode, disallowing memory operations
+ * other than erase. This is initially set to the value set by SECURE_MODE, and cleared by the bootloader
+ * once a memory erase has completed.
+ */
+bool IsSecure = SECURE_MODE;
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
+ * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
+ * jumped to via an indirect jump to location 0x0000 (or other location specified by the host).
+ */
+bool RunBootloader = true;
+
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader is waiting to exit. When the host requests the bootloader to exit and
+ * jump to the application address it specifies, it sends two sequential commands which must be properly
+ * acknowedged. Upon reception of the first the RunBootloader flag is cleared and the WaitForExit flag is set,
+ * causing the bootloader to wait for the final exit command before shutting down.
+ */
+bool WaitForExit = false;
+
+/** Current DFU state machine state, one of the values in the DFU_State_t enum. */
+uint8_t DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+
+/** Status code of the last executed DFU command. This is set to one of the values in the DFU_Status_t enum after
+ * each operation, and returned to the host when a Get Status DFU request is issued.
+ */
+uint8_t DFU_Status = OK;
+
+/** Data containing the DFU command sent from the host. */
+DFU_Command_t SentCommand;
+
+/** Response to the last issued Read Data DFU command. Unlike other DFU commands, the read command
+ * requires a single byte response from the bootloader containing the read data when the next DFU_UPLOAD command
+ * is issued by the host.
+ */
+uint8_t ResponseByte;
+
+/** Pointer to the start of the user application. By default this is 0x0000 (the reset vector), however the host
+ * may specify an alternate address when issuing the application soft-start command.
+ */
+AppPtr_t AppStartPtr = (AppPtr_t)0x0000;
+
+/** 64-bit flash page number. This is concatenated with the current 16-bit address on USB AVRs containing more than
+ * 64KB of flash memory.
+ */
+uint8_t Flash64KBPage = 0;
+
+/** Memory start address, indicating the current address in the memory being addressed (either FLASH or EEPROM
+ * depending on the issued command from the host).
+ */
+uint16_t StartAddr = 0x0000;
+
+/** Memory end address, indicating the end address to read to/write from in the memory being addressed (either FLASH
+ * of EEPROM depending on the issued command from the host).
+ */
+uint16_t EndAddr = 0x0000;
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously
+ * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit, or hard-reset via the watchdog to start
+ * the loaded application code.
+ */
+int main (void)
+{
+ /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+ MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+ wdt_disable();
+
+ /* Disable Clock Division */
+ SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+
+ /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
+
+ /* Initialize the USB subsystem */
+ USB_Init();
+
+ /* Run the USB management task while the bootloader is supposed to be running */
+ while (RunBootloader || WaitForExit)
+ USB_USBTask();
+
+ /* Shut down the USB subsystem */
+ USB_ShutDown();
+
+ /* Relocate the interrupt vector table back to the application section */
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+ MCUCR = 0;
+
+ /* Reset any used hardware ports back to their defaults */
+ PORTD = 0;
+ DDRD = 0;
+
+ #if defined(PORTE)
+ PORTE = 0;
+ DDRE = 0;
+ #endif
+
+ /* Start the user application */
+ AppStartPtr();
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the bootloader should exit and the user
+ * application started.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
+{
+ /* Upon disconnection, run user application */
+ RunBootloader = false;
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ * control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the DFU commands, which are
+ * all issued via the control endpoint), so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+ /* Discard unused wIndex value */
+ Endpoint_Discard_Word();
+
+ /* Discard unused wValue value */
+ Endpoint_Discard_Word();
+
+ /* Get the size of the command and data from the wLength value */
+ SentCommand.DataSize = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+
+ switch (bRequest)
+ {
+ case DFU_DNLOAD:
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Check if bootloader is waiting to terminate */
+ if (WaitForExit)
+ {
+ /* Bootloader is terminating - process last received command */
+ ProcessBootloaderCommand();
+
+ /* Indicate that the last command has now been processed - free to exit bootloader */
+ WaitForExit = false;
+ }
+
+ /* If the request has a data stage, load it into the command struct */
+ if (SentCommand.DataSize)
+ {
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+
+ /* First byte of the data stage is the DNLOAD request's command */
+ SentCommand.Command = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+
+ /* One byte of the data stage is the command, so subtract it from the total data bytes */
+ SentCommand.DataSize--;
+
+ /* Load in the rest of the data stage as command parameters */
+ for (uint8_t DataByte = 0; (DataByte < sizeof(SentCommand.Data)) &&
+ Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint(); DataByte++)
+ {
+ SentCommand.Data[DataByte] = Endpoint_Read_Byte();
+ SentCommand.DataSize--;
+ }
+
+ /* Process the command */
+ ProcessBootloaderCommand();
+ }
+
+ /* Check if currently downloading firmware */
+ if (DFU_State == dfuDNLOAD_IDLE)
+ {
+ if (!(SentCommand.DataSize))
+ {
+ DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Throw away the filler bytes before the start of the firmware */
+ DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE);
+
+ /* Throw away the page alignment filler bytes before the start of the firmware */
+ DiscardFillerBytes(StartAddr % SPM_PAGESIZE);
+
+ /* Calculate the number of bytes remaining to be written */
+ uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1);
+
+ if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Write flash
+ {
+ /* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */
+ uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1);
+
+ union
+ {
+ uint16_t Words[2];
+ uint32_t Long;
+ } CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
+
+ uint32_t CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long;
+ uint8_t WordsInFlashPage = 0;
+
+ while (WordsRemaining--)
+ {
+ /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+ if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ }
+
+ /* Write the next word into the current flash page */
+ boot_page_fill(CurrFlashAddress.Long, Endpoint_Read_Word_LE());
+
+ /* Adjust counters */
+ WordsInFlashPage += 1;
+ CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2;
+
+ /* See if an entire page has been written to the flash page buffer */
+ if ((WordsInFlashPage == (SPM_PAGESIZE >> 1)) || !(WordsRemaining))
+ {
+ /* Commit the flash page to memory */
+ boot_page_write(CurrFlashPageStartAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+ /* Check if programming incomplete */
+ if (WordsRemaining)
+ {
+ CurrFlashPageStartAddress = CurrFlashAddress.Long;
+ WordsInFlashPage = 0;
+
+ /* Erase next page's temp buffer */
+ boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Once programming complete, start address equals the end address */
+ StartAddr = EndAddr;
+
+ /* Re-enable the RWW section of flash */
+ boot_rww_enable();
+ }
+ else // Write EEPROM
+ {
+ while (BytesRemaining--)
+ {
+ /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+ if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ }
+
+ /* Read the byte from the USB interface and write to to the EEPROM */
+ eeprom_write_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr, Endpoint_Read_Byte());
+
+ /* Adjust counters */
+ StartAddr++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Throw away the currently unused DFU file suffix */
+ DiscardFillerBytes(DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE);
+ }
+ }
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+ /* Send ZLP to the host to acknowedge the request */
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+ break;
+ case DFU_UPLOAD:
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+
+ if (DFU_State != dfuUPLOAD_IDLE)
+ {
+ if ((DFU_State == dfuERROR) && IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank Check
+ {
+ /* Blank checking is performed in the DFU_DNLOAD request - if we get here we've told the host
+ that the memory isn't blank, and the host is requesting the first non-blank address */
+ Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(StartAddr);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Idle state upload - send response to last issued command */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(ResponseByte);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Determine the number of bytes remaining in the current block */
+ uint16_t BytesRemaining = ((EndAddr - StartAddr) + 1);
+
+ if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read FLASH
+ {
+ /* Calculate the number of words to be written from the number of bytes to be written */
+ uint16_t WordsRemaining = (BytesRemaining >> 1);
+
+ union
+ {
+ uint16_t Words[2];
+ uint32_t Long;
+ } CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
+
+ while (WordsRemaining--)
+ {
+ /* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+ if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE)
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+ }
+
+ /* Read the flash word and send it via USB to the host */
+ #if defined(RAMPZ)
+ Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(pgm_read_word_far(CurrFlashAddress.Long));
+ #else
+ Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(pgm_read_word(CurrFlashAddress.Long));
+ #endif
+
+ /* Adjust counters */
+ CurrFlashAddress.Long += 2;
+ }
+
+ /* Once reading is complete, start address equals the end address */
+ StartAddr = EndAddr;
+ }
+ else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM
+ {
+ while (BytesRemaining--)
+ {
+ /* Check if endpoint is full - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+ if (Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint() == FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE)
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+ }
+
+ /* Read the EEPROM byte and send it via USB to the host */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(eeprom_read_byte((uint8_t*)StartAddr));
+
+ /* Adjust counters */
+ StartAddr++;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Return to idle state */
+ DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+ }
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+ /* Send ZLP to the host to acknowedge the request */
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+ break;
+ case DFU_GETSTATUS:
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Write 8-bit status value */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_Status);
+
+ /* Write 24-bit poll timeout value */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(0);
+ Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(0);
+
+ /* Write 8-bit state value */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_State);
+
+ /* Write 8-bit state string ID number */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(0);
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+ break;
+ case DFU_CLRSTATUS:
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Reset the status value variable to the default OK status */
+ DFU_Status = OK;
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+ break;
+ case DFU_GETSTATE:
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Write the current device state to the endpoint */
+ Endpoint_Write_Byte(DFU_State);
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+ break;
+ case DFU_ABORT:
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Reset the current state variable to the default idle state */
+ DFU_State = dfuIDLE;
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/** Routine to discard the specified number of bytes from the control endpoint stream. This is used to
+ * discard unused bytes in the stream from the host, including the memory program block suffix.
+ *
+ * \param NumberOfBytes Number of bytes to discard from the host from the control endpoint
+ */
+static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes)
+{
+ while (NumberOfBytes--)
+ {
+ if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+ /* Wait until next data packet received */
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ }
+
+ Endpoint_Discard_Byte();
+ }
+}
+
+/** Routine to process an issued command from the host, via a DFU_DNLOAD request wrapper. This routine ensures
+ * that the command is allowed based on the current secure mode flag value, and passes the command off to the
+ * appropriate handler function.
+ */
+static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void)
+{
+ /* Check if device is in secure mode */
+ if (IsSecure)
+ {
+ /* Don't process command unless it is a READ or chip erase command */
+ if (!(((SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_WRITE) &&
+ IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) ||
+ (SentCommand.Command == COMMAND_READ)))
+ {
+ /* Set the state and status variables to indicate the error */
+ DFU_State = dfuERROR;
+ DFU_Status = errWRITE;
+
+ /* Stall command */
+ Endpoint_StallTransaction();
+
+ /* Don't process the command */
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Dispatch the required command processing routine based on the command type */
+ switch (SentCommand.Command)
+ {
+ case COMMAND_PROG_START:
+ ProcessMemProgCommand();
+ break;
+ case COMMAND_DISP_DATA:
+ ProcessMemReadCommand();
+ break;
+ case COMMAND_WRITE:
+ ProcessWriteCommand();
+ break;
+ case COMMAND_READ:
+ ProcessReadCommand();
+ break;
+ case COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR:
+ if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03, 0x00)) // Set 64KB flash page command
+ Flash64KBPage = SentCommand.Data[2];
+
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/** Routine to concatenate the given pair of 16-bit memory start and end addresses from the host, and store them
+ * in the StartAddr and EndAddr global variables.
+ */
+static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void)
+{
+ union
+ {
+ uint8_t Bytes[2];
+ uint16_t Word;
+ } Address[2] = {{Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[2], SentCommand.Data[1]}},
+ {Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}}};
+
+ /* Load in the start and ending read addresses from the sent data packet */
+ StartAddr = Address[0].Word;
+ EndAddr = Address[1].Word;
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Memory Program command issued by the host. This routine handles the preperations needed
+ * to write subsequent data from the host into the specified memory.
+ */
+static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void)
+{
+ if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Write FLASH command
+ IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Write EEPROM command
+ {
+ /* Load in the start and ending read addresses */
+ LoadStartEndAddresses();
+
+ /* If FLASH is being written to, we need to pre-erase the first page to write to */
+ if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00))
+ {
+ union
+ {
+ uint16_t Words[2];
+ uint32_t Long;
+ } CurrFlashAddress = {Words: {StartAddr, Flash64KBPage}};
+
+ /* Erase the current page's temp buffer */
+ boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress.Long);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+ }
+
+ /* Set the state so that the next DNLOAD requests reads in the firmware */
+ DFU_State = dfuDNLOAD_IDLE;
+ }
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Memory Read command issued by the host. This routine handles the preperations needed
+ * to read subsequent data from the specified memory out to the host, as well as implementing the memory
+ * blank check command.
+ */
+static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void)
+{
+ if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00) || // Read FLASH command
+ IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x02)) // Read EEPROM command
+ {
+ /* Load in the start and ending read addresses */
+ LoadStartEndAddresses();
+
+ /* Set the state so that the next UPLOAD requests read out the firmware */
+ DFU_State = dfuUPLOAD_IDLE;
+ }
+ else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Blank check FLASH command
+ {
+ uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0;
+
+ while (CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR)
+ {
+ /* Check if the current byte is not blank */
+ #if defined(RAMPZ)
+ if (pgm_read_byte_far(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF)
+ #else
+ if (pgm_read_byte(CurrFlashAddress) != 0xFF)
+ #endif
+ {
+ /* Save the location of the first non-blank byte for response back to the host */
+ Flash64KBPage = (CurrFlashAddress >> 16);
+ StartAddr = CurrFlashAddress;
+
+ /* Set state and status variables to the appropriate error values */
+ DFU_State = dfuERROR;
+ DFU_Status = errCHECK_ERASED;
+
+ break;
+ }
+
+ CurrFlashAddress++;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Data Write command issued by the host. This routine handles non-programming commands such as
+ * bootloader exit (both via software jumps and hardware watchdog resets) and flash memory erasure.
+ */
+static void ProcessWriteCommand(void)
+{
+ if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x03)) // Start application
+ {
+ /* Indicate that the bootloader is terminating */
+ WaitForExit = true;
+
+ /* Check if empty request data array - an empty request after a filled request retains the
+ previous valid request data, but initializes the reset */
+ if (!(SentCommand.DataSize))
+ {
+ if (SentCommand.Data[1] == 0x00) // Start via watchdog
+ {
+ /* Start the watchdog to reset the AVR once the communications are finalized */
+ wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS);
+ }
+ else // Start via jump
+ {
+ /* Load in the jump address into the application start address pointer */
+ union
+ {
+ uint8_t Bytes[2];
+ AppPtr_t FuncPtr;
+ } Address = {Bytes: {SentCommand.Data[4], SentCommand.Data[3]}};
+
+ AppStartPtr = Address.FuncPtr;
+
+ /* Set the flag to terminate the bootloader at next opportunity */
+ RunBootloader = false;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else if (IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00, 0xFF)) // Erase flash
+ {
+ uint32_t CurrFlashAddress = 0;
+
+ /* Clear the application section of flash */
+ while (CurrFlashAddress < BOOT_START_ADDR)
+ {
+ boot_page_erase(CurrFlashAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+ boot_page_write(CurrFlashAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+ CurrFlashAddress += SPM_PAGESIZE;
+ }
+
+ /* Re-enable the RWW section of flash as writing to the flash locks it out */
+ boot_rww_enable();
+
+ /* Memory has been erased, reset the security bit so that programming/reading is allowed */
+ IsSecure = false;
+ }
+}
+
+/** Handler for a Data Read command issued by the host. This routine handles bootloader information retrieval
+ * commands such as device signature and bootloader version retrieval.
+ */
+static void ProcessReadCommand(void)
+{
+ const uint8_t BootloaderInfo[3] = {BOOTLOADER_VERSION, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1, BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2};
+ const uint8_t SignatureInfo[3] = {SIGNATURE_BYTE_1, SIGNATURE_BYTE_2, SIGNATURE_BYTE_3};
+
+ uint8_t DataIndexToRead = SentCommand.Data[1];
+
+ if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x00)) // Read bootloader info
+ {
+ ResponseByte = BootloaderInfo[DataIndexToRead];
+ }
+ else if (IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(SentCommand.Data, 0x01)) // Read signature byte
+ {
+ ResponseByte = SignatureInfo[DataIndexToRead - 0x30];
+ }
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..e5c680d2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.h
@@ -0,0 +1,199 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for BootloaderDFU.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _BOOTLOADER_H_
+#define _BOOTLOADER_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <avr/io.h>
+ #include <avr/wdt.h>
+ #include <avr/boot.h>
+ #include <avr/eeprom.h>
+ #include <stdbool.h>
+
+ #include "Descriptors.h"
+
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> // USB Functionality
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** Major bootloader version number. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR 2
+
+ /** Minor bootloader version number. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV 0
+
+ /** Complete bootloder version number expressed as a packed byte, constructed from the
+ * two individual bootloader version macros.
+ */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_VERSION ((BOOTLOADER_VERSION_MINOR << 4) | BOOTLOADER_VERSION_REV)
+
+ /** First byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE1 0xDC
+
+ /** Second byte of the bootloader identification bytes, used to identify a device's bootloader. */
+ #define BOOTLOADER_ID_BYTE2 0xFB
+
+ /** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given one-byte long command.
+ *
+ * \param dataarr Command byte array to check against
+ * \param cb1 First command byte to check
+ */
+ #define IS_ONEBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1) (dataarr[0] == cb1)
+
+ /** Convenience macro, used to determine if the issued command is the given two-byte long command.
+ *
+ * \param dataarr Command byte array to check against
+ * \param cb1 First command byte to check
+ * \param cb2 Second command byte to check
+ */
+ #define IS_TWOBYTE_COMMAND(dataarr, cb1, cb2) ((dataarr[0] == cb1) && (dataarr[1] == cb2))
+
+ /** Length of the DFU file suffix block, appended to the end of each complete memory write command.
+ * The DFU file suffix is currently unused (but is designed to give extra file information, such as
+ * a CRC of the complete firmware for error checking) and so is discarded.
+ */
+ #define DFU_FILE_SUFFIX_SIZE 16
+
+ /** Length of the DFU file filler block, appended to the start of each complete memory write command.
+ * Filler bytes are added to the start of each complete memory write command, and must be discarded.
+ */
+ #define DFU_FILLER_BYTES_SIZE 26
+
+ /** DFU class command request to detatch from the host. */
+ #define DFU_DETATCH 0x00
+
+ /** DFU class command request to send data from the host to the bootloader. */
+ #define DFU_DNLOAD 0x01
+
+ /** DFU class command request to send data from the bootloader to the host. */
+ #define DFU_UPLOAD 0x02
+
+ /** DFU class command request to get the current DFU status and state from the bootloader. */
+ #define DFU_GETSTATUS 0x03
+
+ /** DFU class command request to reset the current DFU status and state variables to their defaults. */
+ #define DFU_CLRSTATUS 0x04
+
+ /** DFU class command request to get the current DFU state of the bootloader. */
+ #define DFU_GETSTATE 0x05
+
+ /** DFU class command request to abort the current multi-request transfer and return to the dfuIDLE state. */
+ #define DFU_ABORT 0x06
+
+ /** DFU command to begin programming the device's memory. */
+ #define COMMAND_PROG_START 0x01
+
+ /** DFU command to begin reading the device's memory. */
+ #define COMMAND_DISP_DATA 0x03
+
+ /** DFU command to issue a write command. */
+ #define COMMAND_WRITE 0x04
+
+ /** DFU command to issue a read command. */
+ #define COMMAND_READ 0x05
+
+ /** DFU command to issue a memory base address change command, to set the current 64KB flash page
+ * that subsequent flash operations should use. */
+ #define COMMAND_CHANGE_BASE_ADDR 0x06
+
+ /* Type Defines: */
+ /** Type define for a non-returning function pointer to the loaded application. */
+ typedef void (*AppPtr_t)(void) ATTR_NO_RETURN;
+
+ /** Type define for a strucuture containing a complete DFU command issued by the host. */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ uint8_t Command; /**< Single byte command to perform, one of the COMMAND_* macro values */
+ uint8_t Data[5]; /**< Command parameters */
+ uint16_t DataSize; /**< Size of the command parameters */
+ } DFU_Command_t;
+
+ /* Enums: */
+ /** DFU bootloader states. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each state. */
+ enum DFU_State_t
+ {
+ appIDLE = 0,
+ appDETACH = 1,
+ dfuIDLE = 2,
+ dfuDNLOAD_SYNC = 3,
+ dfuDNBUSY = 4,
+ dfuDNLOAD_IDLE = 5,
+ dfuMANIFEST_SYNC = 6,
+ dfuMANIFEST = 7,
+ dfuMANIFEST_WAIT_RESET = 8,
+ dfuUPLOAD_IDLE = 9,
+ dfuERROR = 10
+ };
+
+ /** DFU command status error codes. Refer to the DFU class specification for information on each error code. */
+ enum DFU_Status_t
+ {
+ OK = 0,
+ errTARGET = 1,
+ errFILE = 2,
+ errWRITE = 3,
+ errERASE = 4,
+ errCHECK_ERASED = 5,
+ errPROG = 6,
+ errVERIFY = 7,
+ errADDRESS = 8,
+ errNOTDONE = 9,
+ errFIRMWARE = 10,
+ errVENDOR = 11,
+ errUSBR = 12,
+ errPOR = 13,
+ errUNKNOWN = 14,
+ errSTALLEDPKT = 15
+ };
+
+ /* Event Handlers: */
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
+
+ /* Function Prototypes: */
+ #if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_BOOTLOADER_C)
+ static void DiscardFillerBytes(uint8_t NumberOfBytes);
+ static void ProcessBootloaderCommand(void);
+ static void LoadStartEndAddresses(void);
+ static void ProcessMemProgCommand(void);
+ static void ProcessMemReadCommand(void);
+ static void ProcessWriteCommand(void);
+ static void ProcessReadCommand(void);
+ #endif
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..091ce408
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/BootloaderDFU.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
+/** \file
+ *
+ * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ * documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+
+/** \mainpage DFU Class USB AVR Bootloader
+ *
+ * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a DFU Class device, allowing for DFU-compatible programming
+ * software to load firmware onto the AVR.
+ *
+ * This bootloader is compatible with Atmel's FLIP application. However, it requires the use of Atmel's
+ * DFU drivers. You will need to install Atmel's DFU drivers prior to using this bootloader.
+ *
+ * As an open-source option, this bootloader is also compatible with the Linux Atmel USB DFU Programmer
+ * software, available for download at http://sourceforge.net/projects/dfu-programmer/.
+ *
+ * If SECURE_MODE is defined as true, upon startup the bootloader will be locked, with only the chip erase
+ * function available (similar to Atmel's DFU bootloader). If SECURE_MODE is defined as false, all functions
+ * are usable on startup without the prerequisite firmware erase.
+ *
+ * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB1287, and should fit into 4KB of bootloader space. If
+ * you wish to enlarge this space and/or change the AVR model, you will need to edit the BOOT_START and MCU
+ * values in the accompanying makefile.
+ *
+ * <b>NOTE:</b> This device spoofs Atmel's DFU Bootloader USB VID and PID so that the Atmel DFU bootloader
+ * drivers included with FLIP will work. If you do not wish to use Atmel's ID codes, please
+ * manually change them in Descriptors.c and alter your driver's INF file accordingly.
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
+ * <td>Device</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
+ * <td>Device Firmware Update Class (DFU)</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
+ * <td>None</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
+ * <td>USBIF DFU Class Standard, Atmel USB Bootloader Datasheet</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
+ * <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3a1c69c7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.c
@@ -0,0 +1,181 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special
+ * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
+ * the device's capabilities and functions.
+ */
+
+#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall
+ * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
+ * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
+ * process begins.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
+{
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
+
+ USBSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.10),
+ Class: 0x00,
+ SubClass: 0x00,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ Endpoint0Size: FIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE,
+
+ VendorID: 0x03EB,
+ ProductID: PRODUCT_ID_CODE,
+ ReleaseNumber: 0x0000,
+
+ ManufacturerStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+ ProductStrIndex: 0x01,
+ SerialNumStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ NumberOfConfigurations: 1
+};
+
+/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage
+ * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
+ * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
+ * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
+{
+ Config:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
+
+ TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
+ TotalInterfaces: 1,
+
+ ConfigurationNumber: 1,
+ ConfigurationStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ ConfigAttributes: (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
+
+ MaxPowerConsumption: USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
+ },
+
+ DFUInterface:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+ InterfaceNumber: 0,
+ AlternateSetting: 0,
+
+ TotalEndpoints: 0,
+
+ Class: 0xFE,
+ SubClass: 0x01,
+ Protocol: 0x02,
+
+ InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ DFUFunctional:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t), Type: DTYPE_DFUFunctional},
+
+ Attributes: (ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD | ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD),
+
+ DetatchTimeout: 0x0000,
+ TransferSize: 0x0c00,
+
+ DFUSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.01)
+ }
+};
+
+/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests
+ * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
+ * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
+};
+
+/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
+ * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ * Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(18), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: L"AVR DFU Bootloader"
+};
+
+/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
+ * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
+ * to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
+ * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
+ * USB host.
+ */
+uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+{
+ const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8);
+ const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
+
+ void* Address = NULL;
+ uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
+
+ switch (DescriptorType)
+ {
+ case DTYPE_Device:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_Configuration:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_String:
+ if (!(DescriptorNumber))
+ {
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
+ Size = LanguageString.Header.Size;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
+ Size = ProductString.Header.Size;
+ }
+
+ break;
+ }
+
+ *DescriptorAddress = Address;
+ return Size;
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b6d1a2af
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Descriptors.h
@@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for Descriptors.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** Descriptor type value for a DFU class functional descriptor. */
+ #define DTYPE_DFUFunctional 0x21
+
+ /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device will detach and re-attach when a DFU_DETACH
+ * command is issued, rather than the host issing a USB Reset.
+ */
+ #define ATTR_WILL_DETATCH (1 << 3)
+
+ /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can communicate during the manefestation phase
+ * (memory programming phase).
+ */
+ #define ATTR_MANEFESTATION_TOLLERANT (1 << 2)
+
+ /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_UPLOAD requests to send data from
+ * the device to the host.
+ */
+ #define ATTR_CAN_UPLOAD (1 << 1)
+
+ /** DFU attribute mask, indicating that the DFU device can accept DFU_DNLOAD requests to send data from
+ * the host to the device.
+ */
+ #define ATTR_CAN_DOWNLOAD (1 << 0)
+
+ #if defined(__AVR_AT90USB1286__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x97
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
+ #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB1287__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x97
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
+ #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB646__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x96
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
+ #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB647__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF9
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x96
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
+ #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFA
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x94
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
+ #elif defined(__AVR_AT90USB82__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF7
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x94
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x82
+ #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U6__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FFB
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x95
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x88
+ #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega32U4__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF4
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x95
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x87
+ #elif defined(__AVR_ATmega16U4__)
+ #define PRODUCT_ID_CODE 0x2FF3
+
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_1 0x1E
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_2 0x94
+ #define SIGNATURE_BYTE_3 0x88
+ #else
+ #error The selected AVR part is not currently supported by this bootloader.
+ #endif
+
+ #if !defined(PRODUCT_ID_CODE)
+ #error Current AVR model is not supported by this bootloader.
+ #endif
+
+ /* Type Defines: */
+ /** Type define for a DFU class function descriptor. This descriptor gives DFU class information
+ * to the host when read, indicating the DFU device's capabilities.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Standard descriptor header structure */
+
+ uint8_t Attributes; /**< DFU device attributes, a mask comprising of the
+ * ATTR_* macros listed in this source file
+ */
+ uint16_t DetatchTimeout; /**< Timeout in milliseconds between a USB_DETACH
+ * command being issued and the device detaching
+ * from the USB bus
+ */
+ uint16_t TransferSize; /**< Maximum number of bytes the DFU device can accept
+ * from the host in a transaction
+ */
+ uint16_t DFUSpecification; /**< BCD packed DFU specification number this DFU
+ * device complies with
+ */
+ } USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t;
+
+ /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
+ * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
+ * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
+ USB_Descriptor_Interface_t DFUInterface;
+ USB_DFU_Functional_Descriptor_t DFUFunctional;
+ } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
+
+ /* Function Prototypes: */
+ uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+ ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f78e5fde
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/Doxygen.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
+# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
+
+# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
+# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
+#
+# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
+# The format is:
+# TAG = value [value, ...]
+# For lists items can also be appended using:
+# TAG += value [value, ...]
+# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Project related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file
+# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all
+# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the
+# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
+
+DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded
+# by quotes) that should identify the project.
+
+PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - DFU Class Bootloader"
+
+# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number.
+# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or
+# if some version control system is used.
+
+PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.0.0
+
+# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute)
+# base path where the generated documentation will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location
+# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
+
+OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/
+
+# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create
+# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output
+# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories.
+# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of
+# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would
+# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
+
+CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
+
+# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all
+# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this
+# information to generate all constant output in the proper language.
+# The default language is English, other supported languages are:
+# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional,
+# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek,
+# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages),
+# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish,
+# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene,
+# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
+
+OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
+
+# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in
+# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc).
+# Set to NO to disable this.
+
+BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
+
+# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend
+# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description.
+# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the
+# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
+
+REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
+
+# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator
+# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string
+# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be
+# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is
+# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is.
+# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically
+# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget"
+# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains"
+# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
+
+ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
+ "The $name widget" \
+ "The $name file" \
+ is \
+ provides \
+ specifies \
+ contains \
+ represents \
+ a \
+ an \
+ the
+
+# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then
+# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief
+# description.
+
+ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
+
+# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all
+# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those
+# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment
+# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
+
+INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full
+# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set
+# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
+
+FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag
+# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is
+# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of
+# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list.
+# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the
+# path to strip.
+
+STRIP_FROM_PATH =
+
+# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of
+# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells
+# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class.
+# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class
+# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that
+# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
+
+STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
+
+# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter
+# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems
+# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
+
+SHORT_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen
+# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc
+# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments
+# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
+
+JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will
+# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments
+# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring
+# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
+
+QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen
+# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or ///
+# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour.
+# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed
+# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
+
+MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
+
+# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented
+# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it
+# re-implements.
+
+INHERIT_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce
+# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will
+# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
+
+SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
+
+# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab.
+# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
+
+TAB_SIZE = 4
+
+# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts
+# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value".
+# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to
+# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which
+# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:".
+# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
+
+ALIASES =
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C.
+# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list
+# of all members will be omitted, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified
+# scopes will look different, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Fortran.
+
+OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL
+# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for
+# VHDL.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
+
+# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want
+# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should
+# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and
+# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s.
+# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration
+# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
+
+BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
+# enable parsing support.
+
+CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only.
+# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public
+# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
+
+SIP_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter
+# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default)
+# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the
+# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or
+# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the
+# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
+
+IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES
+
+# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC
+# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first
+# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default
+# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
+
+DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
+
+# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of
+# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a
+# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to
+# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using
+# the \nosubgrouping command.
+
+SUBGROUPING = YES
+
+# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum
+# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So
+# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct
+# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file,
+# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically
+# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound
+# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
+
+TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
+
+# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to
+# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
+# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
+# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is
+# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause
+# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time
+# causing a significant performance penality.
+# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the
+# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on
+# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the
+# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula:
+# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0,
+# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
+
+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE = 0
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Build related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in
+# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available.
+# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless
+# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
+
+EXTRACT_ALL = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs)
+# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES
+
+# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local
+# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in
+# the interface are included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO
+
+# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be
+# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called
+# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base
+# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default
+# anonymous namespace are hidden.
+
+EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces.
+# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the
+# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated.
+# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy.
+# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various
+# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# friend (class|struct|union) declarations.
+# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the
+# documentation.
+
+HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any
+# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function.
+# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the
+# function's detailed documentation block.
+
+HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
+
+# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation
+# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set
+# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded.
+# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
+
+INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate
+# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also
+# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ
+# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows
+# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
+
+CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen
+# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the
+# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
+
+HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation
+# of that file.
+
+SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
+
+# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline]
+# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
+
+INLINE_INFO = YES
+
+# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen
+# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members
+# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically
+# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default)
+# the group names will appear in their defined order.
+
+SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be
+# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to
+# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name,
+# not including the namespace part.
+# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
+# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the
+# alphabetical list.
+
+SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting
+# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
+
+# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional
+# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
+
+ENABLED_SECTIONS =
+
+# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines
+# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in
+# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified
+# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely.
+# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the
+# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer
+# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
+
+MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
+
+# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated
+# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the
+# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
+
+SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
+
+# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories
+# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy
+# in the documentation. The default is NO.
+
+SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
+# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the
+# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_FILES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the
+# Namespaces page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
+# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES
+
+# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that
+# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from
+# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via
+# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of
+# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file
+# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output
+# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
+
+FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
+
+# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by
+# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files
+# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents
+# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a
+# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name
+# of the layout file.
+
+LAYOUT_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated
+# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+QUIET = YES
+
+# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are
+# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank
+# NO is used.
+
+WARNINGS = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings
+# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will
+# automatically be disabled.
+
+WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for
+# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some
+# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that
+# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
+
+WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
+
+# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for
+# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters
+# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about
+# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of
+# documentation.
+
+WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES
+
+# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that
+# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text
+# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the
+# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain
+# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could
+# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
+
+WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
+
+# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning
+# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written
+# to stderr.
+
+WARN_LOGFILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the input files
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain
+# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or
+# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories
+# with spaces.
+
+INPUT = ./
+
+# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files
+# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is
+# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built
+# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for
+# the list of possible encodings.
+
+INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank the following patterns are tested:
+# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx
+# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
+
+FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \
+ *.c \
+ *.txt
+
+# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories
+# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO.
+# If left blank NO is used.
+
+RECURSIVE = YES
+
+# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should
+# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a
+# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
+
+EXCLUDE =
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or
+# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded
+# from the input.
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude
+# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched
+# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories
+# for example use the pattern */test/*
+
+EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names
+# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the
+# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the
+# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass,
+# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __*
+
+# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see
+# the \include command).
+
+EXAMPLE_PATH =
+
+# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank all files are included.
+
+EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
+
+# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be
+# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude
+# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag.
+# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
+
+# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see
+# the \image command).
+
+IMAGE_PATH =
+
+# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should
+# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program
+# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter>
+# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an
+# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes
+# to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be
+# ignored.
+
+INPUT_FILTER =
+
+# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern
+# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the
+# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form:
+# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further
+# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER
+# is applied to all files.
+
+FILTER_PATTERNS =
+
+# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using
+# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source
+# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
+
+FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to source browsing
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will
+# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources.
+# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also
+# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
+
+SOURCE_BROWSER = NO
+
+# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body
+# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
+
+INLINE_SOURCES = NO
+
+# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct
+# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code
+# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
+
+STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
+
+# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented
+# functions referencing it will be listed.
+
+REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented entities
+# called/used by that function will be listed.
+
+REFERENCES_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
+# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
+# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
+# link to the source code. Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
+
+REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
+
+# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code
+# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen
+# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source
+# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You
+# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
+
+USE_HTAGS = NO
+
+# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for
+# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
+
+VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index
+# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project
+# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
+
+ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
+
+# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then
+# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns
+# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
+
+COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
+
+# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all
+# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index.
+# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that
+# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
+
+IGNORE_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the HTML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate HTML output.
+
+GENERATE_HTML = YES
+
+# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
+
+HTML_OUTPUT = html
+
+# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for
+# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank
+# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
+
+HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
+
+# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header.
+
+HTML_HEADER =
+
+# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard footer.
+
+HTML_FOOTER =
+
+# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading
+# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to
+# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen
+# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy
+# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own
+# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
+
+HTML_STYLESHEET =
+
+# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes,
+# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to
+# NO a bullet list will be used.
+
+HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
+
+# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML
+# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the
+# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
+
+HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3
+# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard).
+# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the
+# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that
+# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in
+# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find
+# it at startup.
+# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
+
+GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the
+# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple
+# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite)
+# can be grouped.
+
+DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that
+# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a
+# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen
+# will append .docset to the name.
+
+DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the
+# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm)
+# of the generated HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You
+# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be
+# written to the html output directory.
+
+CHM_FILE =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of
+# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run
+# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
+
+HHC_LOCATION =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag
+# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that
+# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
+
+GENERATE_CHI = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
+# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
+# content.
+
+CHM_INDEX_ENCODING =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag
+# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a
+# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
+
+BINARY_TOC = NO
+
+# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members
+# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
+
+TOC_EXPAND = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER
+# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for
+# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated
+# HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_QHP = NO
+
+# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file.
+# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
+
+QCH_FILE =
+
+# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
+
+QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
+
+QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator.
+# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated
+# .qhp file .
+
+QHG_LOCATION =
+
+# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at
+# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and
+# the value YES disables it.
+
+DISABLE_INDEX = NO
+
+# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20])
+# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
+
+ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1
+
+# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
+# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
+# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
+# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that
+# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+,
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are
+# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values
+# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
+# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
+# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
+# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
+# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
+# respectively.
+
+GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
+
+# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be
+# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree
+# is shown.
+
+TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
+
+# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included
+# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that
+# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need
+# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory
+# to force them to be regenerated.
+
+FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate Latex output.
+
+GENERATE_LATEX = NO
+
+# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
+
+LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
+
+# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be
+# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
+
+LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
+
+# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to
+# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the
+# default command name.
+
+MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
+
+# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_LATEX = NO
+
+# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used
+# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and
+# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
+
+PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
+
+# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX
+# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
+
+EXTRA_PACKAGES =
+
+# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for
+# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until
+# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
+
+LATEX_HEADER =
+
+# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated
+# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
+
+PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
+
+# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of
+# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a
+# higher quality PDF documentation.
+
+USE_PDFLATEX = YES
+
+# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode.
+# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep
+# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help.
+# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
+
+LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
+
+# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not
+# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.)
+# in the output.
+
+LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the RTF output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output
+# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with
+# other RTF readers or editors.
+
+GENERATE_RTF = NO
+
+# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
+
+RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
+
+# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_RTF = NO
+
+# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated
+# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references.
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other
+# programs which support those fields.
+# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
+
+RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
+
+# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's
+# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide
+# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
+
+RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
+
+# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document.
+# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
+
+RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the man page output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate man pages
+
+GENERATE_MAN = NO
+
+# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
+
+MAN_OUTPUT = man
+
+# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to
+# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
+
+MAN_EXTENSION = .3
+
+# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output,
+# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity
+# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files
+# only source the real man page, but without them the man command
+# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
+
+MAN_LINKS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the XML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an XML file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation.
+
+GENERATE_XML = NO
+
+# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
+
+XML_OUTPUT = xml
+
+# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_SCHEMA =
+
+# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_DTD =
+
+# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting
+# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that
+# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
+
+XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file
+# that captures the structure of the code including all
+# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental
+# and incomplete at the moment.
+
+GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the Perl module output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation. Note that this
+# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the
+# moment.
+
+GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate
+# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able
+# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
+
+PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be
+# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful
+# if you want to understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this
+# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller
+# and Perl will parse it just the same.
+
+PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
+
+# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file
+# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX.
+# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same
+# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
+
+PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include
+# files.
+
+ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro
+# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional
+# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled
+# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
+
+MACRO_EXPANSION = YES
+
+# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES
+# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the
+# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
+
+EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES
+
+# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files
+# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
+
+SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
+
+# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by
+# the preprocessor.
+
+INCLUDE_PATH =
+
+# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard
+# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the
+# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will
+# be used.
+
+INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
+
+# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that
+# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of
+# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name
+# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are
+# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being
+# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator
+# instead of the = operator.
+
+PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then
+# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded.
+# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used.
+# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
+
+EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = BUTTLOADTAG
+
+# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then
+# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone
+# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such
+# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse
+# the parser if not removed.
+
+SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to external references
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles.
+# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation
+# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without
+# this location is as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ...
+# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ...
+# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or
+# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool
+# does not have to be run to correct the links.
+# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
+# (where the name does NOT include the path)
+# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen
+# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
+
+TAGFILES =
+
+# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create
+# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
+
+GENERATE_TAGFILE =
+
+# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed
+# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes
+# will be listed.
+
+ALLEXTERNALS = NO
+
+# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed
+# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will
+# be listed.
+
+EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
+
+# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script
+# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
+
+PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the dot tool
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base
+# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that
+# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a
+# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more
+# powerful graphs.
+
+CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO
+
+# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc
+# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see
+# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the
+# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where
+# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the
+# default search path.
+
+MSCGEN_PATH =
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide
+# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented
+# or is not a class.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
+
+# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is
+# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization
+# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section
+# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
+
+HAVE_DOT = NO
+
+# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output
+# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This
+# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need
+# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name
+# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font,
+# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the
+# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory
+# containing the font.
+
+DOT_FONTNAME = FreeSans
+
+# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs.
+# The default size is 10pt.
+
+DOT_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the
+# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a
+# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot
+# can find it using this tag.
+
+DOT_FONTPATH =
+
+# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the
+# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
+
+CLASS_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and
+# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
+
+COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
+
+GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
+
+# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and
+# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling
+# Language.
+
+UML_LOOK = NO
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the
+# relations between templates and their instances.
+
+TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT
+# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented
+# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with
+# other documented files.
+
+INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and
+# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each
+# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or
+# indirectly include this file.
+
+INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs
+# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
+
+CALL_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller
+# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
+
+CALLER_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
+
+GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
+
+# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES
+# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories
+# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
+# relations between the files in the directories.
+
+DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images
+# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
+# If left blank png will be used.
+
+DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
+
+# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be
+# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
+
+DOT_PATH = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
+
+# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the
+# \dotfile command).
+
+DOTFILE_DIRS =
+
+# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of
+# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph
+# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is
+# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the
+# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note
+# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
+
+DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15
+
+# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the
+# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable
+# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes
+# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this
+# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large
+# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
+
+MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
+
+# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent
+# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not
+# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used,
+# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of
+# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
+
+DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
+
+# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output
+# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This
+# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10)
+# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
+
+DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and
+# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
+
+GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
+
+# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate
+# the various graphs.
+
+DOT_CLEANUP = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be
+# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
+
+SEARCHENGINE = NO
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d7801745
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/DFU/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,710 @@
+# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, Jörg Wunsch, et al.
+# >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
+#
+# Released to the Public Domain
+#
+# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
+# Peter Fleury
+# Tim Henigan
+# Colin O'Flynn
+# Reiner Patommel
+# Markus Pfaff
+# Sander Pool
+# Frederik Rouleau
+# Carlos Lamas
+# Dean Camera
+# Opendous Inc.
+#
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# On command line:
+#
+# make all = Make software.
+#
+# make clean = Clean out built project files.
+#
+# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
+#
+# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
+#
+# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
+# Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
+#
+# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
+# have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
+# have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
+# (must have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
+# (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
+# DoxyGen installed)
+#
+# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging,
+# with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
+#
+# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
+#
+# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
+# bug reports to the GCC project.
+#
+# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+# MCU name
+MCU = at90usb1287
+
+
+# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
+# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called
+# "Board" inside the application directory.
+BOARD = USBKEY
+
+
+# Processor frequency.
+# This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the
+# processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to
+# calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
+# automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
+# Typical values are:
+# F_CPU = 1000000
+# F_CPU = 1843200
+# F_CPU = 2000000
+# F_CPU = 3686400
+# F_CPU = 4000000
+# F_CPU = 7372800
+# F_CPU = 8000000
+# F_CPU = 11059200
+# F_CPU = 14745600
+# F_CPU = 16000000
+# F_CPU = 18432000
+# F_CPU = 20000000
+F_CPU = 8000000
+
+
+# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
+FORMAT = ihex
+
+
+# Target file name (without extension).
+TARGET = BootloaderDFU
+
+
+# Object files directory
+# To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
+# this an empty or blank macro!
+OBJDIR = .
+
+
+# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+SRC = $(TARGET).c \
+ Descriptors.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c \
+
+# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+CPPSRC =
+
+
+# List Assembler source files here.
+# Make them always end in a capital .S. Files ending in a lowercase .s
+# will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
+# output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
+# Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
+# it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
+# care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
+ASRC =
+
+
+# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s].
+# 0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
+# (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
+OPT = s
+
+
+# Debugging format.
+# Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
+# AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
+# AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
+DEBUG = dwarf-2
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
+
+
+# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
+# c89 = "ANSI" C
+# gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
+# c99 = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
+# gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
+CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
+
+
+# Starting byte address of the bootloader
+BOOT_START = 0x1E000
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
+CDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
+CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=32 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DNO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
+ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
+CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
+CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
+CFLAGS += -fdata-sections
+CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CFLAGS += -fno-inline-small-functions
+CFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
+CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
+CPPFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
+#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns: create listing
+# -gstabs: have the assembler create line number information; note that
+# for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
+# and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
+# files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
+# -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex
+# dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
+ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
+
+
+#---------------- Library Options ----------------
+# Minimalistic printf version
+PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
+
+# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
+PRINTF_LIB =
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+# Minimalistic scanf version
+SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
+
+# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
+SCANF_LIB =
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+MATH_LIB = -lm
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRALIBDIRS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# only used for heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+EXTMEMOPTS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
+# -Wl,...: tell GCC to pass this to linker.
+# -Map: create map file
+# --cref: add cross reference to map file
+LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
+LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
+LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
+LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
+#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
+
+
+
+#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
+
+# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd
+# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
+#
+# Type: avrdude -c ?
+# to get a full listing.
+#
+AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
+
+# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
+AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
+
+AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
+#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
+
+
+# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
+# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
+# see avrdude manual.
+#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
+
+# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
+# performed after programming the device.
+AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
+
+# Increase verbosity level. Please use this when submitting bug
+# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude>
+# to submit bug reports.
+#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
+
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
+
+
+
+#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
+
+# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
+DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
+
+# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
+# DEBUG_UI = gdb
+DEBUG_UI = insight
+
+# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
+DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
+#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
+
+# GDB Init Filename.
+GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
+
+# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
+JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
+
+# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
+DEBUG_PORT = 4242
+
+# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
+# just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when
+# avarice is running on a different computer.
+DEBUG_HOST = localhost
+
+
+
+#============================================================================
+
+
+# Define programs and commands.
+SHELL = sh
+CC = avr-gcc
+OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
+OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
+SIZE = avr-size
+AR = avr-ar rcs
+NM = avr-nm
+AVRDUDE = avrdude
+REMOVE = rm -f
+REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
+COPY = cp
+WINSHELL = cmd
+
+# Define Messages
+# English
+MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
+MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
+MSG_END = -------- end --------
+MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before:
+MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
+MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
+MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
+MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
+MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
+MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
+MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
+MSG_LINKING = Linking:
+MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
+MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
+MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
+MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
+MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
+
+
+
+
+# Define all object files.
+OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+
+# Define all listing files.
+LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+
+
+# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
+GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
+
+
+# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
+# Add target processor to flags.
+ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
+
+
+
+
+
+# Default target.
+all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
+
+# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
+build: elf hex eep lss sym
+#build: lib
+
+
+elf: $(TARGET).elf
+hex: $(TARGET).hex
+eep: $(TARGET).eep
+lss: $(TARGET).lss
+sym: $(TARGET).sym
+LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
+lib: $(LIBNAME)
+
+
+
+# Eye candy.
+# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
+# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
+begin:
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
+
+end:
+ @echo $(MSG_END)
+ @echo
+
+
+# Display size of file.
+HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
+ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) --mcu=$(MCU) --format=avr $(TARGET).elf
+
+sizebefore:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+sizeafter:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+checkhooks: build
+ @echo
+ @echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
+ @$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
+ cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
+ echo "(None)"
+ @echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
+
+checklibmode:
+ @echo
+ @echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
+ @$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
+ | grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
+ || echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
+ @echo ------------------------------------
+
+# Display compiler version information.
+gccversion :
+ @$(CC) --version
+
+
+
+# Program the device.
+program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ $(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
+
+flip: $(TARGET).hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu: $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ mv $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase F memory FLASH erase F
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM
+ loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex memory FLASH loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex
+ program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
+# define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set
+# a breakpoint at main().
+gdb-config:
+ @$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT) >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
+ @echo load >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+endif
+ @echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
+ @echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
+ $(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c pause
+
+else
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
+ $(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
+endif
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+
+
+
+# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
+COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
+
+
+
+coff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+
+# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
+%.hex: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
+ $(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
+
+%.eep: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
+ -$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
+ --change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
+
+# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
+%.lss: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
+ $(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
+
+# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
+%.sym: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
+ $(NM) -n $< > $@
+
+
+
+# Create library from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.a: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
+ $(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
+
+
+# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.elf: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
+ $(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
+%.s : %.c
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
+%.s : %.cpp
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
+%.i : %.c
+ $(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Target: clean project.
+clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
+
+clean_binary:
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
+
+clean_list:
+ @echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+ $(REMOVE) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+ $(REMOVE) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
+ $(REMOVEDIR) .dep
+
+
+doxygen:
+ @echo Generating Project Documentation...
+ @doxygen Doxygen.conf
+ @echo Documentation Generation Complete.
+
+clean_doxygen:
+ rm -rf Documentation
+
+# Create object files directory
+$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
+
+
+# Include the dependency files.
+-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
+
+
+# Listing of phony targets.
+.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin \
+finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion \
+build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff \
+clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
+gdb-config doxygen clean_doxygen
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..adfbe6c2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.c
@@ -0,0 +1,218 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special
+ * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
+ * the device's capabilities and functions.
+ */
+
+#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+/** HID class report descriptor. This is a special descriptor constructed with values from the
+ * USBIF HID class specification to describe the reports and capabilities of the HID device. This
+ * descriptor is parsed by the host and its contents used to determine what data (and in what encoding)
+ * the device will send, and what it may be sent back from the host. Refer to the HID specification for
+ * more details on HID report descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t HIDReport[] =
+{
+ 0x06, 0x9c, 0xff, /* Usage Page (Vendor Defined) */
+ 0x09, 0x19, /* Usage (Vendor Defined) */
+ 0xa1, 0x01, /* Collection (Vendor Defined) */
+ 0x0a, 0x19, 0x00, /* Usage (Vendor Defined) */
+ 0x75, 0x08, /* Report Size (8) */
+ 0x95, 0x82, /* Report Count (130) */
+ 0x15, 0x00, /* Logical Minimum (0) */
+ 0x25, 0xff, /* Logical Maximum (255) */
+ 0x91, 0x02, /* Output (Data, Variable, Absolute) */
+ 0xc0 /* End Collection */
+};
+
+/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall
+ * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
+ * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
+ * process begins.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Device_t DeviceDescriptor =
+{
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
+
+ USBSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.10),
+ Class: 0x00,
+ SubClass: 0x00,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ Endpoint0Size: 8,
+
+ VendorID: 0x16C0,
+ ProductID: 0x0478,
+ ReleaseNumber: 0x0010,
+
+ ManufacturerStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+ ProductStrIndex: 0x01,
+ SerialNumStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ NumberOfConfigurations: 1
+};
+
+/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage
+ * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
+ * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
+ * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t ConfigurationDescriptor =
+{
+ Config:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
+
+ TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
+ TotalInterfaces: 1,
+
+ ConfigurationNumber: 1,
+ ConfigurationStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ ConfigAttributes: (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
+
+ MaxPowerConsumption: USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
+ },
+
+ Interface:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+ InterfaceNumber: 0x00,
+ AlternateSetting: 0x00,
+
+ TotalEndpoints: 1,
+
+ Class: 0x03,
+ SubClass: 0x00,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ HIDDescriptor:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_HID_t), Type: DTYPE_HID},
+
+ HIDSpec: VERSION_BCD(01.11),
+ CountryCode: 0x00,
+ TotalHIDReports: 0x01,
+ HIDReportType: DTYPE_Report,
+ HIDReportLength: sizeof(HIDReport)
+ },
+
+ HIDEndpoint:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+
+ EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | HID_EPNUM),
+ Attributes: EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+ EndpointSize: HID_EPSIZE,
+ PollingIntervalMS: 0x40
+ },
+};
+
+/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests
+ * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
+ * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t LanguageString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
+};
+
+/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
+ * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ * Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t ProductString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(21), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: L"AVR Teensy Bootloader"
+};
+
+/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
+ * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
+ * to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
+ * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
+ * USB host.
+ */
+uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+{
+ const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8);
+ const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
+
+ void* Address = NULL;
+ uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
+
+ switch (DescriptorType)
+ {
+ case DTYPE_Device:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_Configuration:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_String:
+ if (!(DescriptorNumber))
+ {
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
+ Size = LanguageString.Header.Size;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
+ Size = ProductString.Header.Size;
+ }
+
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_HID:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor.HIDDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_HID_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_Report:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(HIDReport);
+ Size = sizeof(HIDReport);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ *DescriptorAddress = Address;
+ return Size;
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..24a0cdaa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Descriptors.h
@@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for Descriptors.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
+
+ /* Type Defines: */
+ /** Type define for the HID class specific HID descriptor, to describe the HID device's specifications. Refer to the HID
+ * specification for details on the structure elements.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header;
+
+ uint16_t HIDSpec;
+ uint8_t CountryCode;
+
+ uint8_t TotalHIDReports;
+
+ uint8_t HIDReportType;
+ uint16_t HIDReportLength;
+ } USB_Descriptor_HID_t;
+
+ /** Type define for the data type used to store HID report descriptor elements. */
+ typedef uint8_t USB_Descriptor_HIDReport_Datatype_t;
+
+ /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
+ * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
+ * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
+ USB_Descriptor_Interface_t Interface;
+ USB_Descriptor_HID_t HIDDescriptor;
+ USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t HIDEndpoint;
+ } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** Endpoint number of the HID data IN endpoint. */
+ #define HID_EPNUM 1
+
+ /** Size in bytes of the HID reporting IN endpoint. */
+ #define HID_EPSIZE 64
+
+ /** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID descriptor. */
+ #define DTYPE_HID 0x21
+
+ /** Descriptor header type value, to indicate a HID class HID report descriptor. */
+ #define DTYPE_Report 0x22
+
+ /* Function Prototypes: */
+ uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+ ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0df2320a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/Doxygen.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
+# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
+
+# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
+# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
+#
+# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
+# The format is:
+# TAG = value [value, ...]
+# For lists items can also be appended using:
+# TAG += value [value, ...]
+# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Project related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file
+# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all
+# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the
+# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
+
+DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded
+# by quotes) that should identify the project.
+
+PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Teensy HID Bootloader"
+
+# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number.
+# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or
+# if some version control system is used.
+
+PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.0.0
+
+# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute)
+# base path where the generated documentation will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location
+# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
+
+OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/
+
+# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create
+# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output
+# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories.
+# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of
+# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would
+# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
+
+CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
+
+# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all
+# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this
+# information to generate all constant output in the proper language.
+# The default language is English, other supported languages are:
+# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional,
+# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek,
+# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages),
+# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish,
+# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene,
+# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
+
+OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
+
+# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in
+# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc).
+# Set to NO to disable this.
+
+BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
+
+# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend
+# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description.
+# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the
+# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
+
+REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
+
+# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator
+# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string
+# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be
+# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is
+# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is.
+# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically
+# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget"
+# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains"
+# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
+
+ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
+ "The $name widget" \
+ "The $name file" \
+ is \
+ provides \
+ specifies \
+ contains \
+ represents \
+ a \
+ an \
+ the
+
+# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then
+# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief
+# description.
+
+ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
+
+# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all
+# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those
+# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment
+# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
+
+INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full
+# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set
+# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
+
+FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag
+# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is
+# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of
+# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list.
+# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the
+# path to strip.
+
+STRIP_FROM_PATH =
+
+# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of
+# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells
+# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class.
+# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class
+# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that
+# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
+
+STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
+
+# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter
+# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems
+# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
+
+SHORT_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen
+# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc
+# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments
+# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
+
+JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will
+# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments
+# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring
+# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
+
+QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen
+# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or ///
+# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour.
+# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed
+# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
+
+MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
+
+# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented
+# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it
+# re-implements.
+
+INHERIT_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce
+# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will
+# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
+
+SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
+
+# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab.
+# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
+
+TAB_SIZE = 4
+
+# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts
+# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value".
+# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to
+# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which
+# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:".
+# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
+
+ALIASES =
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C.
+# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list
+# of all members will be omitted, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified
+# scopes will look different, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Fortran.
+
+OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL
+# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for
+# VHDL.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
+
+# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want
+# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should
+# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and
+# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s.
+# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration
+# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
+
+BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
+# enable parsing support.
+
+CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only.
+# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public
+# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
+
+SIP_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter
+# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default)
+# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the
+# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or
+# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the
+# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
+
+IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES
+
+# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC
+# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first
+# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default
+# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
+
+DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
+
+# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of
+# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a
+# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to
+# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using
+# the \nosubgrouping command.
+
+SUBGROUPING = YES
+
+# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum
+# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So
+# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct
+# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file,
+# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically
+# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound
+# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
+
+TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
+
+# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to
+# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
+# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
+# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is
+# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause
+# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time
+# causing a significant performance penality.
+# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the
+# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on
+# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the
+# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula:
+# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0,
+# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
+
+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE = 0
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Build related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in
+# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available.
+# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless
+# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
+
+EXTRACT_ALL = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs)
+# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES
+
+# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local
+# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in
+# the interface are included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO
+
+# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be
+# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called
+# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base
+# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default
+# anonymous namespace are hidden.
+
+EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces.
+# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the
+# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated.
+# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy.
+# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various
+# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# friend (class|struct|union) declarations.
+# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the
+# documentation.
+
+HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any
+# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function.
+# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the
+# function's detailed documentation block.
+
+HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
+
+# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation
+# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set
+# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded.
+# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
+
+INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate
+# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also
+# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ
+# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows
+# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
+
+CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen
+# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the
+# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
+
+HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation
+# of that file.
+
+SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
+
+# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline]
+# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
+
+INLINE_INFO = YES
+
+# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen
+# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members
+# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically
+# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default)
+# the group names will appear in their defined order.
+
+SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be
+# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to
+# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name,
+# not including the namespace part.
+# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
+# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the
+# alphabetical list.
+
+SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting
+# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
+
+# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional
+# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
+
+ENABLED_SECTIONS =
+
+# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines
+# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in
+# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified
+# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely.
+# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the
+# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer
+# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
+
+MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
+
+# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated
+# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the
+# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
+
+SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
+
+# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories
+# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy
+# in the documentation. The default is NO.
+
+SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
+# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the
+# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_FILES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the
+# Namespaces page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
+# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES
+
+# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that
+# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from
+# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via
+# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of
+# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file
+# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output
+# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
+
+FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
+
+# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by
+# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files
+# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents
+# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a
+# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name
+# of the layout file.
+
+LAYOUT_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated
+# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+QUIET = YES
+
+# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are
+# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank
+# NO is used.
+
+WARNINGS = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings
+# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will
+# automatically be disabled.
+
+WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for
+# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some
+# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that
+# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
+
+WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
+
+# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for
+# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters
+# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about
+# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of
+# documentation.
+
+WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES
+
+# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that
+# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text
+# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the
+# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain
+# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could
+# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
+
+WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
+
+# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning
+# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written
+# to stderr.
+
+WARN_LOGFILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the input files
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain
+# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or
+# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories
+# with spaces.
+
+INPUT = ./
+
+# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files
+# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is
+# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built
+# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for
+# the list of possible encodings.
+
+INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank the following patterns are tested:
+# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx
+# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
+
+FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \
+ *.c \
+ *.txt
+
+# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories
+# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO.
+# If left blank NO is used.
+
+RECURSIVE = YES
+
+# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should
+# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a
+# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
+
+EXCLUDE =
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or
+# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded
+# from the input.
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude
+# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched
+# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories
+# for example use the pattern */test/*
+
+EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names
+# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the
+# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the
+# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass,
+# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __*
+
+# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see
+# the \include command).
+
+EXAMPLE_PATH =
+
+# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank all files are included.
+
+EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
+
+# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be
+# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude
+# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag.
+# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
+
+# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see
+# the \image command).
+
+IMAGE_PATH =
+
+# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should
+# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program
+# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter>
+# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an
+# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes
+# to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be
+# ignored.
+
+INPUT_FILTER =
+
+# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern
+# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the
+# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form:
+# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further
+# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER
+# is applied to all files.
+
+FILTER_PATTERNS =
+
+# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using
+# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source
+# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
+
+FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to source browsing
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will
+# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources.
+# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also
+# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
+
+SOURCE_BROWSER = NO
+
+# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body
+# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
+
+INLINE_SOURCES = NO
+
+# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct
+# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code
+# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
+
+STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
+
+# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented
+# functions referencing it will be listed.
+
+REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented entities
+# called/used by that function will be listed.
+
+REFERENCES_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
+# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
+# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
+# link to the source code. Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
+
+REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
+
+# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code
+# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen
+# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source
+# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You
+# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
+
+USE_HTAGS = NO
+
+# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for
+# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
+
+VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index
+# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project
+# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
+
+ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
+
+# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then
+# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns
+# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
+
+COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
+
+# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all
+# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index.
+# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that
+# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
+
+IGNORE_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the HTML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate HTML output.
+
+GENERATE_HTML = YES
+
+# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
+
+HTML_OUTPUT = html
+
+# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for
+# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank
+# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
+
+HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
+
+# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header.
+
+HTML_HEADER =
+
+# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard footer.
+
+HTML_FOOTER =
+
+# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading
+# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to
+# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen
+# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy
+# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own
+# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
+
+HTML_STYLESHEET =
+
+# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes,
+# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to
+# NO a bullet list will be used.
+
+HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
+
+# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML
+# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the
+# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
+
+HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3
+# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard).
+# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the
+# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that
+# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in
+# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find
+# it at startup.
+# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
+
+GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the
+# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple
+# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite)
+# can be grouped.
+
+DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that
+# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a
+# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen
+# will append .docset to the name.
+
+DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the
+# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm)
+# of the generated HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You
+# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be
+# written to the html output directory.
+
+CHM_FILE =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of
+# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run
+# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
+
+HHC_LOCATION =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag
+# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that
+# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
+
+GENERATE_CHI = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
+# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
+# content.
+
+CHM_INDEX_ENCODING =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag
+# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a
+# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
+
+BINARY_TOC = NO
+
+# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members
+# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
+
+TOC_EXPAND = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER
+# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for
+# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated
+# HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_QHP = NO
+
+# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file.
+# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
+
+QCH_FILE =
+
+# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
+
+QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
+
+QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator.
+# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated
+# .qhp file .
+
+QHG_LOCATION =
+
+# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at
+# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and
+# the value YES disables it.
+
+DISABLE_INDEX = NO
+
+# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20])
+# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
+
+ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1
+
+# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
+# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
+# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
+# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that
+# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+,
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are
+# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values
+# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
+# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
+# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
+# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
+# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
+# respectively.
+
+GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
+
+# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be
+# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree
+# is shown.
+
+TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
+
+# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included
+# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that
+# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need
+# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory
+# to force them to be regenerated.
+
+FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate Latex output.
+
+GENERATE_LATEX = NO
+
+# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
+
+LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
+
+# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be
+# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
+
+LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
+
+# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to
+# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the
+# default command name.
+
+MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
+
+# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_LATEX = NO
+
+# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used
+# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and
+# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
+
+PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
+
+# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX
+# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
+
+EXTRA_PACKAGES =
+
+# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for
+# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until
+# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
+
+LATEX_HEADER =
+
+# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated
+# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
+
+PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
+
+# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of
+# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a
+# higher quality PDF documentation.
+
+USE_PDFLATEX = YES
+
+# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode.
+# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep
+# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help.
+# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
+
+LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
+
+# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not
+# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.)
+# in the output.
+
+LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the RTF output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output
+# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with
+# other RTF readers or editors.
+
+GENERATE_RTF = NO
+
+# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
+
+RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
+
+# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_RTF = NO
+
+# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated
+# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references.
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other
+# programs which support those fields.
+# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
+
+RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
+
+# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's
+# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide
+# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
+
+RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
+
+# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document.
+# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
+
+RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the man page output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate man pages
+
+GENERATE_MAN = NO
+
+# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
+
+MAN_OUTPUT = man
+
+# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to
+# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
+
+MAN_EXTENSION = .3
+
+# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output,
+# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity
+# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files
+# only source the real man page, but without them the man command
+# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
+
+MAN_LINKS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the XML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an XML file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation.
+
+GENERATE_XML = NO
+
+# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
+
+XML_OUTPUT = xml
+
+# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_SCHEMA =
+
+# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_DTD =
+
+# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting
+# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that
+# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
+
+XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file
+# that captures the structure of the code including all
+# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental
+# and incomplete at the moment.
+
+GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the Perl module output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation. Note that this
+# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the
+# moment.
+
+GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate
+# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able
+# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
+
+PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be
+# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful
+# if you want to understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this
+# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller
+# and Perl will parse it just the same.
+
+PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
+
+# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file
+# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX.
+# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same
+# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
+
+PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include
+# files.
+
+ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro
+# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional
+# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled
+# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
+
+MACRO_EXPANSION = YES
+
+# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES
+# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the
+# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
+
+EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES
+
+# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files
+# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
+
+SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
+
+# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by
+# the preprocessor.
+
+INCLUDE_PATH =
+
+# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard
+# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the
+# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will
+# be used.
+
+INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
+
+# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that
+# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of
+# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name
+# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are
+# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being
+# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator
+# instead of the = operator.
+
+PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then
+# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded.
+# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used.
+# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
+
+EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = BUTTLOADTAG
+
+# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then
+# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone
+# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such
+# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse
+# the parser if not removed.
+
+SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to external references
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles.
+# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation
+# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without
+# this location is as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ...
+# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ...
+# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or
+# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool
+# does not have to be run to correct the links.
+# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
+# (where the name does NOT include the path)
+# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen
+# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
+
+TAGFILES =
+
+# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create
+# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
+
+GENERATE_TAGFILE =
+
+# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed
+# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes
+# will be listed.
+
+ALLEXTERNALS = NO
+
+# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed
+# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will
+# be listed.
+
+EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
+
+# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script
+# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
+
+PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the dot tool
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base
+# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that
+# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a
+# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more
+# powerful graphs.
+
+CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO
+
+# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc
+# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see
+# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the
+# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where
+# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the
+# default search path.
+
+MSCGEN_PATH =
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide
+# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented
+# or is not a class.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
+
+# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is
+# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization
+# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section
+# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
+
+HAVE_DOT = NO
+
+# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output
+# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This
+# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need
+# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name
+# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font,
+# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the
+# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory
+# containing the font.
+
+DOT_FONTNAME = FreeSans
+
+# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs.
+# The default size is 10pt.
+
+DOT_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the
+# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a
+# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot
+# can find it using this tag.
+
+DOT_FONTPATH =
+
+# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the
+# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
+
+CLASS_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and
+# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
+
+COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
+
+GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
+
+# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and
+# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling
+# Language.
+
+UML_LOOK = NO
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the
+# relations between templates and their instances.
+
+TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT
+# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented
+# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with
+# other documented files.
+
+INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and
+# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each
+# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or
+# indirectly include this file.
+
+INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs
+# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
+
+CALL_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller
+# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
+
+CALLER_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
+
+GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
+
+# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES
+# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories
+# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
+# relations between the files in the directories.
+
+DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images
+# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
+# If left blank png will be used.
+
+DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
+
+# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be
+# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
+
+DOT_PATH = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
+
+# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the
+# \dotfile command).
+
+DOTFILE_DIRS =
+
+# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of
+# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph
+# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is
+# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the
+# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note
+# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
+
+DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15
+
+# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the
+# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable
+# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes
+# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this
+# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large
+# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
+
+MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
+
+# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent
+# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not
+# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used,
+# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of
+# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
+
+DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
+
+# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output
+# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This
+# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10)
+# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
+
+DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and
+# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
+
+GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
+
+# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate
+# the various graphs.
+
+DOT_CLEANUP = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be
+# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
+
+SEARCHENGINE = NO
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4f09ac50
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.c
@@ -0,0 +1,156 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Main source file for the TeensyHID bootloader. This file contains the complete bootloader logic.
+ */
+
+#define INCLUDE_FROM_TEENSYHID_C
+#include "TeensyHID.h"
+
+/* Global Variables: */
+/** Flag to indicate if the bootloader should be running, or should exit and allow the application code to run
+ * via a soft reset. When cleared, the bootloader will abort, the USB interface will shut down and the application
+ * started via a forced watchdog reset.
+ */
+bool RunBootloader = true;
+
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the bootloader, then continuously
+ * runs the bootloader processing routine until instructed to soft-exit.
+ */
+int main(void)
+{
+ /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+ MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+ wdt_disable();
+
+ /* Disable Clock Division */
+ SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+
+ /* Relocate the interrupt vector table to the bootloader section */
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVCE);
+ MCUCR = (1 << IVSEL);
+
+ /* Initialize USB subsystem */
+ USB_Init();
+
+ while (RunBootloader)
+ USB_USBTask();
+
+ /* Shut down the USB interface, so that the host will register the disconnection */
+ USB_ShutDown();
+
+ /* Wait 100ms to give the host time to register the disconnection */
+ _delay_ms(100);
+
+ /* Enable the watchdog and force a timeout to reset the AVR */
+ wdt_enable(WDTO_250MS);
+
+ for (;;);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This configures the device's endpoints ready
+ * to relay data to and from the attached USB host.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
+{
+ /* Setup HID Report Endpoint */
+ Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(HID_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_INTERRUPT,
+ ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, HID_EPSIZE,
+ ENDPOINT_BANK_SINGLE);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ * control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the HID commands, which are
+ * all issued via the control endpoint), so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+ /* Handle HID Class specific requests */
+ switch (bRequest)
+ {
+ case REQ_SetReport:
+ if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_CLASS | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Wait until the command (report) has been sent by the host */
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+
+ /* Read in the write destination address */
+ uint16_t PageAddress = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+
+ /* Check if the command is a program page command, or a start application command */
+ if (PageAddress == TEENSY_STARTAPPLICATION)
+ {
+ RunBootloader = false;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Erase the given FLASH page, ready to be programmed */
+ boot_page_erase(PageAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+ /* Write each of the FLASH page's bytes in sequence */
+ for (uint8_t PageByte = 0; PageByte < 128; PageByte += 2)
+ {
+ /* Check if endpoint is empty - if so clear it and wait until ready for next packet */
+ if (!(Endpoint_BytesInEndpoint()))
+ {
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupOUTReceived()));
+ }
+
+ /* Write the next data word to the FLASH page */
+ boot_page_fill(PageAddress + PageByte, Endpoint_Read_Word_LE());
+ }
+
+ /* Write the filled FLASH page to memory */
+ boot_page_write(PageAddress);
+ boot_spm_busy_wait();
+
+ /* Re-enable RWW section */
+ boot_rww_enable();
+ }
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupOUT();
+
+ /* Wait until the host is ready to receive the request confirmation */
+ while (!(Endpoint_IsSetupINReady()));
+
+ /* Handshake the request by sending an empty IN packet */
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+ }
+
+ break;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a53fca30
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.h
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for TeensyHID.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _TEENSYHID_H_
+#define _TEENSYHID_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <avr/io.h>
+ #include <avr/wdt.h>
+ #include <avr/boot.h>
+ #include <avr/wdt.h>
+ #include <util/delay.h>
+ #include <stdbool.h>
+
+ #include "Descriptors.h"
+
+ #include <LUFA/Version.h> // Library Version Information
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> // USB Functionality
+
+ /* Preprocessor Checks: */
+ #if !defined(__AVR_AT90USB162__)
+ #error This bootloader is not compatible with the selected AVR model.
+ #endif
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** HID Class specific request to send the next HID report to the device. */
+ #define REQ_SetReport 0x09
+
+ #define TEENSY_STARTAPPLICATION 0xFFFF
+
+ /* Event Handlers: */
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_ConfigurationChanged event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_ConfigurationChanged);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..973819cf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/TeensyHID.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+/** \file
+ *
+ * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ * documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+
+/** \mainpage Teensy HID Class USB AVR Bootloader
+ *
+ * This bootloader enumerates to the host as a HID Class device, allowing for Teensy compatible programming
+ * software to load firmware onto the AVR, such as the official software at http://www.pjrc.com/teensy/.
+ *
+ * Out of the box this bootloader builds for the USB162, and will fit into 2KB of bootloader space.
+ *
+ * This spoofs (with permission) the offical Teensy bootloader's VID and PID, so that the software remains
+ * compatible with no changes.
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
+ * <td>Device</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
+ * <td>Human Interface Device Class (HID)</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
+ * <td>N/A</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
+ * <td>USBIF HID Class Standard</td>
+ * <td>Teensy Programming Protocol Details</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
+ * <td>Low Speed Mode</td>
+ * <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..5d40a0f4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/TeensyHID/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,707 @@
+# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, Jörg Wunsch, et al.
+# >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
+#
+# Released to the Public Domain
+#
+# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
+# Peter Fleury
+# Tim Henigan
+# Colin O'Flynn
+# Reiner Patommel
+# Markus Pfaff
+# Sander Pool
+# Frederik Rouleau
+# Carlos Lamas
+# Dean Camera
+# Opendous Inc.
+#
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# On command line:
+#
+# make all = Make software.
+#
+# make clean = Clean out built project files.
+#
+# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
+#
+# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
+#
+# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
+# Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
+#
+# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
+# have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
+# have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
+# (must have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
+# (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
+# DoxyGen installed)
+#
+# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging,
+# with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
+#
+# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
+#
+# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
+# bug reports to the GCC project.
+#
+# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+# MCU name
+MCU = at90usb162
+
+
+# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
+# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called
+# "Board" inside the application directory.
+BOARD = USBKEY
+
+
+# Processor frequency.
+# This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the
+# processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to
+# calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
+# automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
+# Typical values are:
+# F_CPU = 1000000
+# F_CPU = 1843200
+# F_CPU = 2000000
+# F_CPU = 3686400
+# F_CPU = 4000000
+# F_CPU = 7372800
+# F_CPU = 8000000
+# F_CPU = 11059200
+# F_CPU = 14745600
+# F_CPU = 16000000
+# F_CPU = 18432000
+# F_CPU = 20000000
+F_CPU = 8000000
+
+
+# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
+FORMAT = ihex
+
+
+# Target file name (without extension).
+TARGET = TeensyHID
+
+
+# Object files directory
+# To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
+# this an empty or blank macro!
+OBJDIR = .
+
+
+# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+SRC = $(TARGET).c \
+ Descriptors.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c \
+
+# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+CPPSRC =
+
+
+# List Assembler source files here.
+# Make them always end in a capital .S. Files ending in a lowercase .s
+# will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
+# output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
+# Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
+# it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
+# care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
+ASRC =
+
+
+# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s].
+# 0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
+# (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
+OPT = s
+
+
+# Debugging format.
+# Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
+# AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
+# AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
+DEBUG = dwarf-2
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
+
+
+# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
+# c89 = "ANSI" C
+# gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
+# c99 = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
+# gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
+CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
+
+
+# Starting byte address of the bootloader
+BOOT_START = 0xC000
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
+CDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DSTATIC_ENDPOINT_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
+CDEFS += -DUSE_RAM_DESCRIPTORS -DBOOT_START_ADDR=$(BOOT_START)UL -DFIXED_CONTROL_ENDPOINT_SIZE=8 -DUSE_SINGLE_DEVICE_CONFIGURATION
+CDEFS += -DNO_CLEARSET_FEATURE_REQUEST
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
+ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
+CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
+CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
+CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CFLAGS += -finline-limit=20
+CFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
+CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
+CPPFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
+#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns: create listing
+# -gstabs: have the assembler create line number information; note that
+# for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
+# and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
+# files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
+# -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex
+# dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
+ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
+
+
+#---------------- Library Options ----------------
+# Minimalistic printf version
+PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
+
+# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
+PRINTF_LIB =
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+# Minimalistic scanf version
+SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
+
+# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
+SCANF_LIB =
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+MATH_LIB = -lm
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRALIBDIRS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# only used for heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+EXTMEMOPTS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
+# -Wl,...: tell GCC to pass this to linker.
+# -Map: create map file
+# --cref: add cross reference to map file
+LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--section-start=.text=$(BOOT_START)
+LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
+LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
+LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
+#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
+
+
+
+#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
+
+# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd
+# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
+#
+# Type: avrdude -c ?
+# to get a full listing.
+#
+AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
+
+# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
+AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
+
+AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
+#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
+
+
+# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
+# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
+# see avrdude manual.
+#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
+
+# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
+# performed after programming the device.
+#AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
+
+# Increase verbosity level. Please use this when submitting bug
+# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude>
+# to submit bug reports.
+#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
+
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
+
+
+
+#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
+
+# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
+DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
+
+# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
+# DEBUG_UI = gdb
+DEBUG_UI = insight
+
+# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
+DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
+#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
+
+# GDB Init Filename.
+GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
+
+# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
+JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
+
+# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
+DEBUG_PORT = 4242
+
+# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
+# just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when
+# avarice is running on a different computer.
+DEBUG_HOST = localhost
+
+
+
+#============================================================================
+
+
+# Define programs and commands.
+SHELL = sh
+CC = avr-gcc
+OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
+OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
+SIZE = avr-size
+AR = avr-ar rcs
+NM = avr-nm
+AVRDUDE = avrdude
+REMOVE = rm -f
+REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
+COPY = cp
+WINSHELL = cmd
+
+# Define Messages
+# English
+MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
+MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
+MSG_END = -------- end --------
+MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before:
+MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
+MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
+MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
+MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
+MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
+MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
+MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
+MSG_LINKING = Linking:
+MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
+MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
+MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
+MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
+MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
+
+
+
+
+# Define all object files.
+OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+
+# Define all listing files.
+LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+
+
+# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
+GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
+
+
+# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
+# Add target processor to flags.
+ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
+
+
+
+
+
+# Default target.
+all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
+
+# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
+build: elf hex eep lss sym
+#build: lib
+
+
+elf: $(TARGET).elf
+hex: $(TARGET).hex
+eep: $(TARGET).eep
+lss: $(TARGET).lss
+sym: $(TARGET).sym
+LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
+lib: $(LIBNAME)
+
+
+
+# Eye candy.
+# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
+# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
+begin:
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
+
+end:
+ @echo $(MSG_END)
+ @echo
+
+
+# Display size of file.
+HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
+ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) --mcu=$(MCU) --format=avr $(TARGET).elf
+
+sizebefore:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+sizeafter:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+checkhooks: build
+ @echo
+ @echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
+ @$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
+ cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
+ echo "(None)"
+ @echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
+
+checklibmode:
+ @echo
+ @echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
+ @$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
+ | grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
+ || echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
+ @echo ------------------------------------
+
+# Display compiler version information.
+gccversion :
+ @$(CC) --version
+
+
+
+# Program the device.
+program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ $(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
+
+flip: $(TARGET).hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu: $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ mv $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase F memory FLASH erase F
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM
+ loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex memory FLASH loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex
+ program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
+# define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set
+# a breakpoint at main().
+gdb-config:
+ @$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT) >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
+ @echo load >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+endif
+ @echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
+ @echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
+ $(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c pause
+
+else
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
+ $(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
+endif
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+
+
+
+# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
+COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
+
+
+
+coff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+
+# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
+%.hex: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
+ $(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
+
+%.eep: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
+ -$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
+ --change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
+
+# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
+%.lss: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
+ $(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
+
+# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
+%.sym: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
+ $(NM) -n $< > $@
+
+
+
+# Create library from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.a: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
+ $(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
+
+
+# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.elf: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
+ $(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
+%.s : %.c
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
+%.s : %.cpp
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
+%.i : %.c
+ $(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Target: clean project.
+clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
+
+clean_binary:
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
+
+clean_list:
+ @echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
+ $(REMOVEDIR) .dep
+
+
+doxygen:
+ @echo Generating Project Documentation...
+ @doxygen Doxygen.conf
+ @echo Documentation Generation Complete.
+
+clean_doxygen:
+ rm -rf Documentation
+
+# Create object files directory
+$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
+
+
+# Include the dependency files.
+-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
+
+
+# Listing of phony targets.
+.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin \
+finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion \
+build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff \
+clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
+gdb-config doxygen
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..78af34d6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Bootloaders/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+#
+# LUFA Library
+# Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+#
+# dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+# www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+#
+
+# Makefile to build all the LUFA USB Bootloaders. Call with "make all" to
+# rebuild all bootloaders.
+
+# Bootloaders are pre-cleaned before each one is built, to ensure any
+# custom LUFA library build options are reflected in the compiled
+# code.
+
+all:
+ make -C 'DFU/' clean
+ make -C 'DFU/' all
+
+ make -C 'CDC/' clean
+ make -C 'CDC/' all
+
+ make -C 'TeensyHID/' clean
+ make -C 'TeensyHID/' all
+
+%:
+ make -C 'DFU/' $@
+ make -C 'CDC/' $@
+ make -C 'TeensyHID/' $@
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.aps b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.aps
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..aed850ae
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.aps
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>AudioInput</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:03:00</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:03:28</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:03:00</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile>AudioInput.elf</ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Demos\AudioInput\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM></COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>AudioInput.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>AudioInput.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>AudioInput.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><ProjectFiles><Files><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Demos\AudioInput\AudioInput.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Demos\AudioInput\Descriptors.h</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Demos\AudioInput\AudioInput.c</Name><Name>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Demos\AudioInput\Descriptors.c</Name></Files></ProjectFiles><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f5474b49
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.c
@@ -0,0 +1,231 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Main source file for the Audio Input demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and
+ * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration.
+ */
+
+/* --- Project Configuration --- */
+//#define MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL
+/* --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- */
+
+#include "AudioInput.h"
+
+/* Project Tags, for reading out using the ButtLoad project */
+BUTTLOADTAG(ProjName, "LUFA AudioIn App");
+BUTTLOADTAG(BuildTime, __TIME__);
+BUTTLOADTAG(BuildDate, __DATE__);
+BUTTLOADTAG(LUFAVersion, "LUFA V" LUFA_VERSION_STRING);
+
+/* Scheduler Task List */
+TASK_LIST
+{
+ { Task: USB_USBTask , TaskStatus: TASK_STOP },
+ { Task: USB_Audio_Task , TaskStatus: TASK_STOP },
+};
+
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then
+ * starts the scheduler to run the application tasks.
+ */
+int main(void)
+{
+ /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+ MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+ wdt_disable();
+
+ /* Disable Clock Division */
+ SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+
+ /* Hardware Initialization */
+ LEDs_Init();
+ ADC_Init(ADC_FREE_RUNNING | ADC_PRESCALE_32);
+ ADC_SetupChannel(MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL);
+
+ /* Start the ADC conversion in free running mode */
+ ADC_StartReading(ADC_REFERENCE_AVCC | ADC_RIGHT_ADJUSTED | MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL);
+
+ /* Indicate USB not ready */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBNotReady);
+
+ /* Initialize Scheduler so that it can be used */
+ Scheduler_Init();
+
+ /* Initialize USB Subsystem */
+ USB_Init();
+
+ /* Scheduling - routine never returns, so put this last in the main function */
+ Scheduler_Start();
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs, and
+ * configures the sample update and PWM timers.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Connect)
+{
+ /* Start USB management task */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_USBTask, TASK_RUN);
+
+ /* Indicate USB enumerating */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBEnumerating);
+
+ /* Sample reload timer initialization */
+ OCR0A = (F_CPU / AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQUENCY);
+ TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode
+ TCCR0B = (1 << CS00); // Fcpu speed
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via
+ * the status LEDs, disables the sample update and PWM output timers and stops the USB and Audio management tasks.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
+{
+ /* Stop the sample reload timer */
+ TCCR0B = 0;
+
+ /* Stop running audio and USB management tasks */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_Audio_Task, TASK_STOP);
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_USBTask, TASK_STOP);
+
+ /* Indicate USB not ready */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBNotReady);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration
+ * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
+{
+ /* Setup audio stream endpoint */
+ Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS,
+ ENDPOINT_DIR_IN, AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE,
+ ENDPOINT_BANK_DOUBLE);
+
+ /* Indicate USB connected and ready */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBReady);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ * control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the Audio class-specific
+ * requests) so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+ /* Process General and Audio specific control requests */
+ switch (bRequest)
+ {
+ case REQ_SetInterface:
+ /* Set Interface is not handled by the library, as its function is application-specific */
+ if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+ {
+ uint16_t wValue = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Check if the host is enabling the audio interface (setting AlternateSetting to 1) */
+ if (wValue)
+ {
+ /* Start audio task */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_Audio_Task, TASK_RUN);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Stop audio task */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_Audio_Task, TASK_STOP);
+ }
+
+ /* Handshake the request */
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+ }
+
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/** Function to manage status updates to the user. This is done via LEDs on the given board, if available, but may be changed to
+ * log to a serial port, or anything else that is suitable for status updates.
+ *
+ * \param CurrentStatus Current status of the system, from the AudioInput_StatusCodes_t enum
+ */
+void UpdateStatus(uint8_t CurrentStatus)
+{
+ uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS;
+
+ /* Set the LED mask to the appropriate LED mask based on the given status code */
+ switch (CurrentStatus)
+ {
+ case Status_USBNotReady:
+ LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1);
+ break;
+ case Status_USBEnumerating:
+ LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2);
+ break;
+ case Status_USBReady:
+ LEDMask = (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Set the board LEDs to the new LED mask */
+ LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask);
+}
+
+/** Task to manage the Audio interface, reading in ADC samples from the microphone, and them to the host. */
+TASK(USB_Audio_Task)
+{
+ /* Select the audio stream endpoint */
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM);
+
+ /* Check if the current endpoint can be read from (contains a packet) and that the next sample should be stored */
+ if (Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed() && (TIFR0 & (1 << OCF0A)))
+ {
+ /* Clear the sample reload timer */
+ TIFR0 |= (1 << OCF0A);
+
+ /* Audio sample is ADC value scaled to fit the entire range */
+ int16_t AudioSample = ((SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / ADC_MAX_RANGE) * ADC_GetResult());
+
+#if defined(MICROPHONE_BIASED_TO_HALF_RAIL)
+ /* Microphone is biased to half rail voltage, subtract the bias from the sample value */
+ AudioSample -= (SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE / 2));
+#endif
+
+ /* Write the sample to the buffer */
+ Endpoint_Write_Word_LE(AudioSample);
+
+ /* Check to see if the bank is now full */
+ if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
+ {
+ /* Send the full packet to the host */
+ Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+ }
+ }
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..97978fde
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.h
@@ -0,0 +1,90 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for AudioOutput.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_
+#define _AUDIO_OUTPUT_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <avr/io.h>
+ #include <avr/wdt.h>
+
+ #include "Descriptors.h"
+
+ #include <LUFA/Version.h> // Library Version Information
+ #include <LUFA/Common/ButtLoadTag.h> // PROGMEM tags readable by the ButtLoad project
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> // USB Functionality
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/LEDs.h> // LEDs driver
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/AT90USBXXX/ADC.h> // ADC driver
+ #include <LUFA/Scheduler/Scheduler.h> // Simple scheduler for task management
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** ADC channel number for the microphone input. */
+ #define MIC_IN_ADC_CHANNEL 2
+
+ /** Maximum ADC sample value for the microphone input. */
+ #define SAMPLE_MAX_RANGE 0xFFFF
+
+ /** Maximum ADC range for the microphone input. */
+ #define ADC_MAX_RANGE 0x3FF
+
+ /* Enums: */
+ /** Enum for the possible status codes for passing to the UpdateStatus() function. */
+ enum AudioInput_StatusCodes_t
+ {
+ Status_USBNotReady = 0, /**< USB is not ready (disconnected from a USB host) */
+ Status_USBEnumerating = 1, /**< USB interface is enumerating */
+ Status_USBReady = 2, /**< USB interface is connected and ready */
+ };
+
+ /* Task Definitions: */
+ TASK(USB_Audio_Task);
+
+ /* Event Handlers: */
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Connect event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Connect);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_Disconnect event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_Disconnect);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_ConfigurationChanged event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_ConfigurationChanged);
+
+ /** Indicates that this module will catch the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event when thrown by the library. */
+ HANDLES_EVENT(USB_UnhandledControlPacket);
+
+ /* Function Prototypes: */
+ void UpdateStatus(uint8_t CurrentStatus);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..09b77f7e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/AudioInput.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
+/** \file
+ *
+ * This file contains special DoxyGen information for the generation of the main page and other special
+ * documentation pages. It is not a project source file.
+ */
+
+/** \mainpage Audio Input Device Demo
+ *
+ * Audio demonstration application. This gives a simple reference
+ * application for implementing a USB Audio Input device using the
+ * basic USB Audio drivers in all modern OSes (i.e. no special drivers
+ * required).
+ *
+ * On startup the system will automatically enumerate and function
+ * as a USB microphone. Incomming audio from the ADC channel 1 will
+ * be sampled and sent to the host computer.
+ *
+ * To use, connect a microphone to the ADC channel 2.
+ *
+ * Under Windows, if a driver request dialogue pops up, select the option
+ * to automatically install the appropriate drivers.
+ *
+ *
+ * <table>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Mode:</b></td>
+ * <td>Device</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Class:</b></td>
+ * <td>Audio Class</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>USB Subclass:</b></td>
+ * <td>Standard Audio Device</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Relevant Standards:</b></td>
+ * <td>USBIF Audio Class Specification</td>
+ * <td>USBIF Audio Class Terminal Types Specification</td>
+ * <td>USBIF Audio Data Formats Specification</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * <tr>
+ * <td><b>Usable Speeds:</b></td>
+ * <td>Full Speed Mode</td>
+ * </tr>
+ * </table>
+ */ \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..7a3e4288
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.c
@@ -0,0 +1,314 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * USB Device Descriptors, for library use when in USB device mode. Descriptors are special
+ * computer-readable structures which the host requests upon device enumeration, to determine
+ * the device's capabilities and functions.
+ */
+
+#include "Descriptors.h"
+
+/** Device descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the overall
+ * device characteristics, including the supported USB version, control endpoint size and the
+ * number of device configurations. The descriptor is read out by the USB host when the enumeration
+ * process begins.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Device_t PROGMEM DeviceDescriptor =
+{
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t), Type: DTYPE_Device},
+
+ USBSpecification: VERSION_BCD(02.00),
+ Class: 0x00,
+ SubClass: 0x00,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ Endpoint0Size: 8,
+
+ VendorID: 0x03EB,
+ ProductID: 0x2047,
+ ReleaseNumber: 0x0000,
+
+ ManufacturerStrIndex: 0x01,
+ ProductStrIndex: 0x02,
+ SerialNumStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ NumberOfConfigurations: 1
+};
+
+/** Configuration descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, describes the usage
+ * of the device in one of its supported configurations, including information about any device interfaces
+ * and endpoints. The descriptor is read out by the USB host during the enumeration process when selecting
+ * a configuration so that the host may correctly communicate with the USB device.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t PROGMEM ConfigurationDescriptor =
+{
+ Config:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t), Type: DTYPE_Configuration},
+
+ TotalConfigurationSize: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t),
+ TotalInterfaces: 2,
+
+ ConfigurationNumber: 1,
+ ConfigurationStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+
+ ConfigAttributes: (USB_CONFIG_ATTR_BUSPOWERED | USB_CONFIG_ATTR_SELFPOWERED),
+
+ MaxPowerConsumption: USB_CONFIG_POWER_MA(100)
+ },
+
+ AudioControlInterface:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+ InterfaceNumber: 0,
+ AlternateSetting: 0,
+
+ TotalEndpoints: 0,
+
+ Class: 0x01,
+ SubClass: 0x01,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ AudioControlInterface_SPC:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_AudioInterface_AC_t), Type: DTYPE_AudioInterface},
+ Subtype: DSUBTYPE_Header,
+
+ ACSpecification: VERSION_BCD(01.00),
+ TotalLength: (sizeof(USB_AudioInterface_AC_t) +
+ sizeof(USB_AudioInputTerminal_t) +
+ sizeof(USB_AudioOutputTerminal_t)),
+
+ InCollection: 1,
+ InterfaceNumbers: {1},
+ },
+
+ InputTerminal:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_AudioInputTerminal_t), Type: DTYPE_AudioInterface},
+ Subtype: DSUBTYPE_InputTerminal,
+
+ TerminalID: 0x01,
+ TerminalType: TERMINAL_IN_MIC,
+ AssociatedOutputTerminal: 0x00,
+
+ TotalChannels: 1,
+ ChannelConfig: 0,
+
+ ChannelStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR,
+ TerminalStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ OutputTerminal:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_AudioOutputTerminal_t), Type: DTYPE_AudioInterface},
+ Subtype: DSUBTYPE_OutputTerminal,
+
+ TerminalID: 0x02,
+ TerminalType: TERMINAL_STREAMING,
+ AssociatedInputTerminal: 0x00,
+
+ SourceID: 0x01,
+
+ TerminalStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ AudioStreamInterface_Alt0:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+ InterfaceNumber: 1,
+ AlternateSetting: 0,
+
+ TotalEndpoints: 0,
+
+ Class: 0x01,
+ SubClass: 0x02,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ AudioStreamInterface_Alt1:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Interface_t), Type: DTYPE_Interface},
+
+ InterfaceNumber: 1,
+ AlternateSetting: 1,
+
+ TotalEndpoints: 1,
+
+ Class: 0x01,
+ SubClass: 0x02,
+ Protocol: 0x00,
+
+ InterfaceStrIndex: NO_DESCRIPTOR
+ },
+
+ AudioStreamInterface_SPC:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_AudioInterface_AS_t), Type: DTYPE_AudioInterface},
+ Subtype: DSUBTYPE_General,
+
+ TerminalLink: 0x02,
+
+ FrameDelay: 1,
+ AudioFormat: 0x0001
+ },
+
+ AudioFormat:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_AudioFormat_t), Type: DTYPE_AudioInterface},
+ Subtype: DSUBTYPE_Format,
+
+ FormatType: 0x01,
+ Channels: 0x01,
+
+ SubFrameSize: 0x02,
+ BitResolution: 16,
+ SampleFrequencyType: (sizeof(ConfigurationDescriptor.AudioFormat.SampleFrequencies) / sizeof(AudioSampleFreq_t)),
+
+ SampleFrequencies: {SAMPLE_FREQ(AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQUENCY)}
+ },
+
+ AudioEndpoint:
+ {
+ Endpoint:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_AudioStreamEndpoint_Std_t), Type: DTYPE_Endpoint},
+
+ EndpointAddress: (ENDPOINT_DESCRIPTOR_DIR_IN | AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM),
+ Attributes: (EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS | ENDPOINT_ATTR_SYNC | ENDPOINT_USAGE_DATA),
+ EndpointSize: AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE,
+ PollingIntervalMS: 1
+ },
+
+ Refresh: 0,
+ SyncEndpointNumber: 0
+ },
+
+ AudioEndpoint_SPC:
+ {
+ Header: {Size: sizeof(USB_AudioStreamEndpoint_Spc_t), Type: DTYPE_AudioEndpoint},
+ Subtype: DSUBTYPE_General,
+
+ Attributes: 0x00,
+
+ LockDelayUnits: 0x00,
+ LockDelay: 0x0000
+ }
+};
+
+/** Language descriptor structure. This descriptor, located in FLASH memory, is returned when the host requests
+ * the string descriptor with index 0 (the first index). It is actually an array of 16-bit integers, which indicate
+ * via the language ID table available at USB.org what languages the device supports for its string descriptors.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM LanguageString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(1), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: {LANGUAGE_ID_ENG}
+};
+
+/** Manufacturer descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the manufacturer's details in human readable
+ * form, and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ * Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ManufacturerString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(11), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: L"Dean Camera"
+};
+
+/** Product descriptor string. This is a Unicode string containing the product's details in human readable form,
+ * and is read out upon request by the host when the appropriate string ID is requested, listed in the Device
+ * Descriptor.
+ */
+USB_Descriptor_String_t PROGMEM ProductString =
+{
+ Header: {Size: USB_STRING_LEN(18), Type: DTYPE_String},
+
+ UnicodeString: L"LUFA Audio In Demo"
+};
+
+/** This function is called by the library when in device mode, and must be overridden (see StdDescriptors.h
+ * documentation) by the application code so that the address and size of a requested descriptor can be given
+ * to the USB library. When the device recieves a Get Descriptor request on the control endpoint, this function
+ * is called so that the descriptor details can be passed back and the appropriate descriptor sent back to the
+ * USB host.
+ */
+uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+{
+ const uint8_t DescriptorType = (wValue >> 8);
+ const uint8_t DescriptorNumber = (wValue & 0xFF);
+
+ void* Address = NULL;
+ uint16_t Size = NO_DESCRIPTOR;
+
+ switch (DescriptorType)
+ {
+ case DTYPE_Device:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(DeviceDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Device_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_Configuration:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ConfigurationDescriptor);
+ Size = sizeof(USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t);
+ break;
+ case DTYPE_String:
+ switch (DescriptorNumber)
+ {
+ case 0x00:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(LanguageString);
+ Size = pgm_read_byte(&LanguageString.Header.Size);
+ break;
+ case 0x01:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ManufacturerString);
+ Size = pgm_read_byte(&ManufacturerString.Header.Size);
+ break;
+ case 0x02:
+ Address = DESCRIPTOR_ADDRESS(ProductString);
+ Size = pgm_read_byte(&ProductString.Header.Size);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ break;
+ }
+
+ *DescriptorAddress = Address;
+ return Size;
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..cc007498
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Descriptors.h
@@ -0,0 +1,322 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Header file for Descriptors.c.
+ */
+
+#ifndef _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+#define _DESCRIPTORS_H_
+
+ /* Includes: */
+ #include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h>
+
+ #include <avr/pgmspace.h>
+
+ /* Macros: */
+ /** Descriptor header constant to indicate a Audio class interface descriptor. */
+ #define DTYPE_AudioInterface 0x24
+
+ /** Descriptor header constant to indicate a Audio class endpoint descriptor. */
+ #define DTYPE_AudioEndpoint 0x25
+
+ /** Audio class descriptor subtype value for a Audio class specific header descriptor. */
+ #define DSUBTYPE_Header 0x01
+
+ /** Audio class descriptor subtype value for an Output Terminal Audio class specific descriptor. */
+ #define DSUBTYPE_InputTerminal 0x02
+
+ /** Audio class descriptor subtype value for an Input Terminal Audio class specific descriptor. */
+ #define DSUBTYPE_OutputTerminal 0x03
+
+ /** Audio class descriptor subtype value for a Feature Unit Audio class specific descriptor. */
+ #define DSUBTYPE_FeatureUnit 0x06
+
+ /** Audio class descriptor subtype value for a general Audio class specific descriptor. */
+ #define DSUBTYPE_General 0x01
+
+ /** Audio class descriptor subtype value for an Audio class specific descriptor indicating the format of an audio stream. */
+ #define DSUBTYPE_Format 0x02
+
+ //@{
+ /** Supported channel mask for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */
+
+ #define CHANNEL_LEFT_FRONT (1 << 0)
+ #define CHANNEL_RIGHT_FRONT (1 << 1)
+ #define CHANNEL_CENTER_FRONT (1 << 2)
+ #define CHANNEL_LOW_FREQ_ENHANCE (1 << 3)
+ #define CHANNEL_LEFT_SURROUND (1 << 4)
+ #define CHANNEL_RIGHT_SURROUND (1 << 5)
+ #define CHANNEL_LEFT_OF_CENTER (1 << 6)
+ #define CHANNEL_RIGHT_OF_CENTER (1 << 7)
+ #define CHANNEL_SURROUND (1 << 8)
+ #define CHANNEL_SIDE_LEFT (1 << 9)
+ #define CHANNEL_SIDE_RIGHT (1 << 10)
+ #define CHANNEL_TOP (1 << 11)
+ //@}
+
+ //@{
+ /** Supported feature mask for an Audio class feature unit descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */
+
+ #define FEATURE_MUTE (1 << 0)
+ #define FEATURE_VOLUME (1 << 1)
+ #define FEATURE_BASS (1 << 2)
+ #define FEATURE_MID (1 << 3)
+ #define FEATURE_TREBLE (1 << 4)
+ #define FEATURE_GRAPHIC_EQUALIZER (1 << 5)
+ #define FEATURE_AUTOMATIC_GAIN (1 << 6)
+ #define FEATURE_DELAY (1 << 7)
+ #define FEATURE_BASS_BOOST (1 << 8)
+ #define FEATURE_BASS_LOUDNESS (1 << 9)
+ //@}
+
+ //@{
+ /** Terminal type constant for an Audio class terminal descriptor. See the Audio class specification for more details. */
+
+ #define TERMINAL_UNDEFINED 0x0100
+ #define TERMINAL_STREAMING 0x0101
+ #define TERMINAL_VENDOR 0x01FF
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_UNDEFINED 0x0200
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_MIC 0x0201
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_DESKTOP_MIC 0x0202
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_PERSONAL_MIC 0x0203
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_OMNIDIR_MIC 0x0204
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_MIC_ARRAY 0x0205
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_PROCESSING_MIC 0x0206
+ #define TERMINAL_IN_OUT_UNDEFINED 0x0300
+ #define TERMINAL_OUT_SPEAKER 0x0301
+ #define TERMINAL_OUT_HEADPHONES 0x0302
+ #define TERMINAL_OUT_HEAD_MOUNTED 0x0303
+ #define TERMINAL_OUT_DESKTOP 0x0304
+ #define TERMINAL_OUT_ROOM 0x0305
+ #define TERMINAL_OUT_COMMUNICATION 0x0306
+ #define TERMINAL_OUT_LOWFREQ 0x0307
+ //@}
+
+ /** Convenience macro, to fill a 24-bit AudioSampleFreq_t structure with the given sample rate as a 24-bit number.
+ *
+ * \param freq Required audio sampling frequency in HZ
+ */
+ #define SAMPLE_FREQ(freq) {LowWord: ((uint32_t)freq & 0x00FFFF), HighByte: (((uint32_t)freq >> 16) & 0x0000FF)}
+
+ /** Mask for the attributes parameter of an Audio class specific Endpoint descriptor, indicating that the endpoint
+ * accepts only filled endpoint packets of audio samples.
+ */
+ #define EP_ACCEPTS_ONLY_FULL_PACKETS (1 << 7)
+
+ /** Mask for the attributes parameter of an Audio class specific Endpoint descriptor, indicating that the endpoint
+ * will accept partially filled endpoint packets of audio samples.
+ */
+ #define EP_ACCEPTS_SMALL_PACKETS (0 << 7)
+
+ #if defined(USB_FULL_CONTROLLER) || defined(__DOXYGEN__)
+ /** Endpoint number of the Audio isochronous streaming data endpoint. */
+ #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM 1
+ #else
+ #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM 3
+ #endif
+
+ /** Endpoint size in bytes of the Audio isochronous streaming data endpoint. The Windows audio stack requires
+ * at least 192 bytes for correct output, thus the smaller 128 byte maximum endpoint size on some of the smaller
+ * USB AVR models will result in unavoidable distorted output.
+ */
+ #define AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE ENDPOINT_MAX_SIZE(AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM)
+
+ /** Sample frequency of the data being transmitted through the streaming endpoint. */
+ #define AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQUENCY 48000
+
+ /* Type Defines: */
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific interface descriptor. This follows a regular interface descriptor to
+ * supply extra information about the audio device's layout to the host. See the USB Audio specification for more
+ * details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length */
+ uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class specific descriptors */
+
+ uint16_t ACSpecification; /**< Binary coded decimal value, indicating the supported Audio Class specification version */
+ uint16_t TotalLength; /**< Total length of the Audio class specific descriptors, including this descriptor */
+
+ uint8_t InCollection; /**< Total number of audio class interfaces within this device */
+ uint8_t InterfaceNumbers[1]; /**< Interface numbers of each audio interface */
+ } USB_AudioInterface_AC_t;
+
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific Feature Unit descriptor. This indicates to the host what features
+ * are present in the device's audio stream for basic control, such as per-channel volume. See the USB Audio
+ * specification for more details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length */
+ uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class specific descriptors */
+
+ uint8_t UnitID; /**< ID value of this feature unit - must be a unique value within the device */
+ uint8_t SourceID; /**< Source ID value of the audio source input into this feature unit */
+
+ uint8_t ControlSize; /**< Size of each element in the ChanelControlls array */
+ uint8_t ChannelControls[3]; /**< Feature masks for the control channel, and each seperate audio channel */
+
+ uint8_t FeatureUnitStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device */
+ } USB_AudioFeatureUnit_t;
+
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific input terminal descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device
+ * contains an input audio source, either from a physical terminal on the device, or a logical terminal (for example,
+ * a USB endpoint). See the USB Audio specification for more details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length */
+ uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class specific descriptors */
+
+ uint8_t TerminalID; /**< ID value of this terminal unit - must be a unique value within the device */
+ uint16_t TerminalType; /**< Type of terminal, a TERMINAL_* mask */
+ uint8_t AssociatedOutputTerminal; /**< ID of associated output terminal, for physically grouped terminals
+ * such as the speaker and microphone of a phone handset
+ */
+ uint8_t TotalChannels; /**< Total number of seperate audio channels within this interface (right, left, etc.) */
+ uint16_t ChannelConfig; /**< CHANNEL_* masks indicating what channel layout is supported by this terminal */
+
+ uint8_t ChannelStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this channel within the device */
+ uint8_t TerminalStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device */
+ } USB_AudioInputTerminal_t;
+
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific output terminal descriptor. This indicates to the host that the device
+ * contains an output audio sink, either to a physical terminal on the device, or a logical terminal (for example,
+ * a USB endpoint). See the USB Audio specification for more details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length */
+ uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class specific descriptors */
+
+ uint8_t TerminalID; /**< ID value of this terminal unit - must be a unique value within the device */
+ uint16_t TerminalType; /**< Type of terminal, a TERMINAL_* mask */
+ uint8_t AssociatedInputTerminal; /**< ID of associated input terminal, for physically grouped terminals
+ * such as the speaker and microphone of a phone handset
+ */
+ uint8_t SourceID; /**< ID value of the unit this terminal's audio is sourced from */
+
+ uint8_t TerminalStrIndex; /**< Index of a string descriptor describing this descriptor within the device */
+ } USB_AudioOutputTerminal_t;
+
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific streaming interface descriptor. This indicates to the host
+ * how audio streams within the device are formatted. See the USB Audio specification for more details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length */
+ uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class specific descriptors */
+
+ uint8_t TerminalLink; /**< ID value of the output terminal this descriptor is describing */
+
+ uint8_t FrameDelay; /**< Delay in frames resulting from the complete sample processing from input to output */
+ uint16_t AudioFormat; /**< Format of the audio stream, see Audio Device Formats specification */
+ } USB_AudioInterface_AS_t;
+
+ /** Type define for a 24bit audio sample frequency structure. GCC does not contain a built in 24bit datatype,
+ * this this structure is used to build up the value instead. Fill this structure with the SAMPLE_FREQ() macro.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ uint16_t LowWord; /**< Low 16 bits of the 24-bit value */
+ uint8_t HighByte; /**< Upper 8 bits of the 24-bit value */
+ } AudioSampleFreq_t;
+
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific audio format descriptor. This is used to give the host full details
+ * about the number of channels, the sample resolution, acceptable sample frequencies and encoding method used
+ * in the device's audio streams. See the USB Audio specification for more details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length */
+ uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class specific descriptors */
+
+ uint8_t FormatType; /**< Format of the audio stream, see Audio Device Formats specification */
+ uint8_t Channels; /**< Total number of discrete channels in the stream */
+
+ uint8_t SubFrameSize; /**< Size in bytes of each channel's sample data in the stream */
+ uint8_t BitResolution; /**< Bits of resolution of each channel's samples in the stream */
+
+ uint8_t SampleFrequencyType; /**< Total number of sample frequencies supported by the device */
+ AudioSampleFreq_t SampleFrequencies[1]; /**< Sample frequencies supported by the device */
+ } USB_AudioFormat_t;
+
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific endpoint descriptor. This contains a regular endpoint
+ * descriptor with a few Audio-class specific extensions. See the USB Audio specification for more details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Endpoint_t Endpoint; /**< Standard endpoint descriptor describing the audio endpoint */
+
+ uint8_t Refresh; /**< Always set to zero */
+ uint8_t SyncEndpointNumber; /**< Endpoint address to send synchronisation information to, if needed (zero otherwise) */
+ } USB_AudioStreamEndpoint_Std_t;
+
+ /** Type define for an Audio class specific extended endpoint descriptor. This contains extra information
+ * on the usage of endpoints used to stream audio in and out of the USB Audio device, and follows an Audio
+ * class specific extended endpoint descriptor. See the USB Audio specification for more details.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Header_t Header; /**< Regular descriptor header containing the descriptor's type and length */
+ uint8_t Subtype; /**< Sub type value used to distinguish between audio class specific descriptors */
+
+ uint8_t Attributes; /**< Audio class specific endpoint attributes, such as ACCEPTS_SMALL_PACKETS */
+
+ uint8_t LockDelayUnits; /**< Units used for the LockDelay field, see Audio class specification */
+ uint16_t LockDelay; /**< Time required to internally lock endpoint's internal clock recovery circuitry */
+ } USB_AudioStreamEndpoint_Spc_t;
+
+ /** Type define for the device configuration descriptor structure. This must be defined in the
+ * application code, as the configuration descriptor contains several sub-descriptors which
+ * vary between devices, and which describe the device's usage to the host.
+ */
+ typedef struct
+ {
+ USB_Descriptor_Configuration_Header_t Config;
+ USB_Descriptor_Interface_t AudioControlInterface;
+ USB_AudioInterface_AC_t AudioControlInterface_SPC;
+ USB_AudioInputTerminal_t InputTerminal;
+ USB_AudioOutputTerminal_t OutputTerminal;
+ USB_Descriptor_Interface_t AudioStreamInterface_Alt0;
+ USB_Descriptor_Interface_t AudioStreamInterface_Alt1;
+ USB_AudioInterface_AS_t AudioStreamInterface_SPC;
+ USB_AudioFormat_t AudioFormat;
+ USB_AudioStreamEndpoint_Std_t AudioEndpoint;
+ USB_AudioStreamEndpoint_Spc_t AudioEndpoint_SPC;
+ } USB_Descriptor_Configuration_t;
+
+ /* Function Prototypes: */
+ uint16_t USB_GetDescriptor(const uint16_t wValue, const uint8_t wIndex, void** const DescriptorAddress)
+ ATTR_WARN_UNUSED_RESULT ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3);
+
+#endif
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Doxygen.conf b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Doxygen.conf
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f84efb7b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/Doxygen.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,1485 @@
+# Doxyfile 1.5.7.1
+
+# This file describes the settings to be used by the documentation system
+# doxygen (www.doxygen.org) for a project
+#
+# All text after a hash (#) is considered a comment and will be ignored
+# The format is:
+# TAG = value [value, ...]
+# For lists items can also be appended using:
+# TAG += value [value, ...]
+# Values that contain spaces should be placed between quotes (" ")
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Project related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# This tag specifies the encoding used for all characters in the config file
+# that follow. The default is UTF-8 which is also the encoding used for all
+# text before the first occurrence of this tag. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the
+# iconv built into libc) for the transcoding. See
+# http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for the list of possible encodings.
+
+DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# The PROJECT_NAME tag is a single word (or a sequence of words surrounded
+# by quotes) that should identify the project.
+
+PROJECT_NAME = "LUFA Library - Audio Input Device Demo"
+
+# The PROJECT_NUMBER tag can be used to enter a project or revision number.
+# This could be handy for archiving the generated documentation or
+# if some version control system is used.
+
+PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.0.0
+
+# The OUTPUT_DIRECTORY tag is used to specify the (relative or absolute)
+# base path where the generated documentation will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered, it will be relative to the location
+# where doxygen was started. If left blank the current directory will be used.
+
+OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = ./Documentation/
+
+# If the CREATE_SUBDIRS tag is set to YES, then doxygen will create
+# 4096 sub-directories (in 2 levels) under the output directory of each output
+# format and will distribute the generated files over these directories.
+# Enabling this option can be useful when feeding doxygen a huge amount of
+# source files, where putting all generated files in the same directory would
+# otherwise cause performance problems for the file system.
+
+CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
+
+# The OUTPUT_LANGUAGE tag is used to specify the language in which all
+# documentation generated by doxygen is written. Doxygen will use this
+# information to generate all constant output in the proper language.
+# The default language is English, other supported languages are:
+# Afrikaans, Arabic, Brazilian, Catalan, Chinese, Chinese-Traditional,
+# Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Farsi, Finnish, French, German, Greek,
+# Hungarian, Italian, Japanese, Japanese-en (Japanese with English messages),
+# Korean, Korean-en, Lithuanian, Norwegian, Macedonian, Persian, Polish,
+# Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Serbian-Cyrilic, Slovak, Slovene,
+# Spanish, Swedish, and Ukrainian.
+
+OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
+
+# If the BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# include brief member descriptions after the members that are listed in
+# the file and class documentation (similar to JavaDoc).
+# Set to NO to disable this.
+
+BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
+
+# If the REPEAT_BRIEF tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will prepend
+# the brief description of a member or function before the detailed description.
+# Note: if both HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS and BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC are set to NO, the
+# brief descriptions will be completely suppressed.
+
+REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
+
+# This tag implements a quasi-intelligent brief description abbreviator
+# that is used to form the text in various listings. Each string
+# in this list, if found as the leading text of the brief description, will be
+# stripped from the text and the result after processing the whole list, is
+# used as the annotated text. Otherwise, the brief description is used as-is.
+# If left blank, the following values are used ("$name" is automatically
+# replaced with the name of the entity): "The $name class" "The $name widget"
+# "The $name file" "is" "provides" "specifies" "contains"
+# "represents" "a" "an" "the"
+
+ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
+ "The $name widget" \
+ "The $name file" \
+ is \
+ provides \
+ specifies \
+ contains \
+ represents \
+ a \
+ an \
+ the
+
+# If the ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC and REPEAT_BRIEF tags are both set to YES then
+# Doxygen will generate a detailed section even if there is only a brief
+# description.
+
+ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
+
+# If the INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB tag is set to YES, doxygen will show all
+# inherited members of a class in the documentation of that class as if those
+# members were ordinary class members. Constructors, destructors and assignment
+# operators of the base classes will not be shown.
+
+INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then Doxygen will prepend the full
+# path before files name in the file list and in the header files. If set
+# to NO the shortest path that makes the file name unique will be used.
+
+FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the FULL_PATH_NAMES tag is set to YES then the STRIP_FROM_PATH tag
+# can be used to strip a user-defined part of the path. Stripping is
+# only done if one of the specified strings matches the left-hand part of
+# the path. The tag can be used to show relative paths in the file list.
+# If left blank the directory from which doxygen is run is used as the
+# path to strip.
+
+STRIP_FROM_PATH =
+
+# The STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH tag can be used to strip a user-defined part of
+# the path mentioned in the documentation of a class, which tells
+# the reader which header file to include in order to use a class.
+# If left blank only the name of the header file containing the class
+# definition is used. Otherwise one should specify the include paths that
+# are normally passed to the compiler using the -I flag.
+
+STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
+
+# If the SHORT_NAMES tag is set to YES, doxygen will generate much shorter
+# (but less readable) file names. This can be useful is your file systems
+# doesn't support long names like on DOS, Mac, or CD-ROM.
+
+SHORT_NAMES = YES
+
+# If the JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen
+# will interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a JavaDoc-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the JavaDoc
+# comments will behave just like regular Qt-style comments
+# (thus requiring an explicit @brief command for a brief description.)
+
+JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# If the QT_AUTOBRIEF tag is set to YES then Doxygen will
+# interpret the first line (until the first dot) of a Qt-style
+# comment as the brief description. If set to NO, the comments
+# will behave just like regular Qt-style comments (thus requiring
+# an explicit \brief command for a brief description.)
+
+QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
+
+# The MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF tag can be set to YES to make Doxygen
+# treat a multi-line C++ special comment block (i.e. a block of //! or ///
+# comments) as a brief description. This used to be the default behaviour.
+# The new default is to treat a multi-line C++ comment block as a detailed
+# description. Set this tag to YES if you prefer the old behaviour instead.
+
+MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
+
+# If the INHERIT_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then an undocumented
+# member inherits the documentation from any documented member that it
+# re-implements.
+
+INHERIT_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES tag is set to YES, then doxygen will produce
+# a new page for each member. If set to NO, the documentation of a member will
+# be part of the file/class/namespace that contains it.
+
+SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
+
+# The TAB_SIZE tag can be used to set the number of spaces in a tab.
+# Doxygen uses this value to replace tabs by spaces in code fragments.
+
+TAB_SIZE = 4
+
+# This tag can be used to specify a number of aliases that acts
+# as commands in the documentation. An alias has the form "name=value".
+# For example adding "sideeffect=\par Side Effects:\n" will allow you to
+# put the command \sideeffect (or @sideeffect) in the documentation, which
+# will result in a user-defined paragraph with heading "Side Effects:".
+# You can put \n's in the value part of an alias to insert newlines.
+
+ALIASES =
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C tag to YES if your project consists of C
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for C.
+# For instance, some of the names that are used will be different. The list
+# of all members will be omitted, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA tag to YES if your project consists of Java
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Java. For instance, namespaces will be presented as packages, qualified
+# scopes will look different, etc.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN tag to YES if your project consists of Fortran
+# sources only. Doxygen will then generate output that is more tailored for
+# Fortran.
+
+OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
+
+# Set the OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL tag to YES if your project consists of VHDL
+# sources. Doxygen will then generate output that is tailored for
+# VHDL.
+
+OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
+
+# If you use STL classes (i.e. std::string, std::vector, etc.) but do not want
+# to include (a tag file for) the STL sources as input, then you should
+# set this tag to YES in order to let doxygen match functions declarations and
+# definitions whose arguments contain STL classes (e.g. func(std::string); v.s.
+# func(std::string) {}). This also make the inheritance and collaboration
+# diagrams that involve STL classes more complete and accurate.
+
+BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# If you use Microsoft's C++/CLI language, you should set this option to YES to
+# enable parsing support.
+
+CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# Set the SIP_SUPPORT tag to YES if your project consists of sip sources only.
+# Doxygen will parse them like normal C++ but will assume all classes use public
+# instead of private inheritance when no explicit protection keyword is present.
+
+SIP_SUPPORT = NO
+
+# For Microsoft's IDL there are propget and propput attributes to indicate getter
+# and setter methods for a property. Setting this option to YES (the default)
+# will make doxygen to replace the get and set methods by a property in the
+# documentation. This will only work if the methods are indeed getting or
+# setting a simple type. If this is not the case, or you want to show the
+# methods anyway, you should set this option to NO.
+
+IDL_PROPERTY_SUPPORT = YES
+
+# If member grouping is used in the documentation and the DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC
+# tag is set to YES, then doxygen will reuse the documentation of the first
+# member in the group (if any) for the other members of the group. By default
+# all members of a group must be documented explicitly.
+
+DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
+
+# Set the SUBGROUPING tag to YES (the default) to allow class member groups of
+# the same type (for instance a group of public functions) to be put as a
+# subgroup of that type (e.g. under the Public Functions section). Set it to
+# NO to prevent subgrouping. Alternatively, this can be done per class using
+# the \nosubgrouping command.
+
+SUBGROUPING = YES
+
+# When TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT is enabled, a typedef of a struct, union, or enum
+# is documented as struct, union, or enum with the name of the typedef. So
+# typedef struct TypeS {} TypeT, will appear in the documentation as a struct
+# with name TypeT. When disabled the typedef will appear as a member of a file,
+# namespace, or class. And the struct will be named TypeS. This can typically
+# be useful for C code in case the coding convention dictates that all compound
+# types are typedef'ed and only the typedef is referenced, never the tag name.
+
+TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
+
+# The SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE determines the size of the internal cache use to
+# determine which symbols to keep in memory and which to flush to disk.
+# When the cache is full, less often used symbols will be written to disk.
+# For small to medium size projects (<1000 input files) the default value is
+# probably good enough. For larger projects a too small cache size can cause
+# doxygen to be busy swapping symbols to and from disk most of the time
+# causing a significant performance penality.
+# If the system has enough physical memory increasing the cache will improve the
+# performance by keeping more symbols in memory. Note that the value works on
+# a logarithmic scale so increasing the size by one will rougly double the
+# memory usage. The cache size is given by this formula:
+# 2^(16+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE). The valid range is 0..9, the default is 0,
+# corresponding to a cache size of 2^16 = 65536 symbols
+
+SYMBOL_CACHE_SIZE = 0
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Build related configuration options
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the EXTRACT_ALL tag is set to YES doxygen will assume all entities in
+# documentation are documented, even if no documentation was available.
+# Private class members and static file members will be hidden unless
+# the EXTRACT_PRIVATE and EXTRACT_STATIC tags are set to YES
+
+EXTRACT_ALL = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_PRIVATE tag is set to YES all private members of a class
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_PRIVATE = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_STATIC tag is set to YES all static members of a file
+# will be included in the documentation.
+
+EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
+
+# If the EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES tag is set to YES classes (and structs)
+# defined locally in source files will be included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO only classes defined in header files are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = YES
+
+# This flag is only useful for Objective-C code. When set to YES local
+# methods, which are defined in the implementation section but not in
+# the interface are included in the documentation.
+# If set to NO (the default) only methods in the interface are included.
+
+EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = NO
+
+# If this flag is set to YES, the members of anonymous namespaces will be
+# extracted and appear in the documentation as a namespace called
+# 'anonymous_namespace{file}', where file will be replaced with the base
+# name of the file that contains the anonymous namespace. By default
+# anonymous namespace are hidden.
+
+EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented members of documented classes, files or namespaces.
+# If set to NO (the default) these members will be included in the
+# various overviews, but no documentation section is generated.
+# This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# undocumented classes that are normally visible in the class hierarchy.
+# If set to NO (the default) these classes will be included in the various
+# overviews. This option has no effect if EXTRACT_ALL is enabled.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide all
+# friend (class|struct|union) declarations.
+# If set to NO (the default) these declarations will be included in the
+# documentation.
+
+HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS tag is set to YES, Doxygen will hide any
+# documentation blocks found inside the body of a function.
+# If set to NO (the default) these blocks will be appended to the
+# function's detailed documentation block.
+
+HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
+
+# The INTERNAL_DOCS tag determines if documentation
+# that is typed after a \internal command is included. If the tag is set
+# to NO (the default) then the documentation will be excluded.
+# Set it to YES to include the internal documentation.
+
+INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the CASE_SENSE_NAMES tag is set to NO then Doxygen will only generate
+# file names in lower-case letters. If set to YES upper-case letters are also
+# allowed. This is useful if you have classes or files whose names only differ
+# in case and if your file system supports case sensitive file names. Windows
+# and Mac users are advised to set this option to NO.
+
+CASE_SENSE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES tag is set to NO (the default) then Doxygen
+# will show members with their full class and namespace scopes in the
+# documentation. If set to YES the scope will be hidden.
+
+HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will put a list of the files that are included by a file in the documentation
+# of that file.
+
+SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
+
+# If the INLINE_INFO tag is set to YES (the default) then a tag [inline]
+# is inserted in the documentation for inline members.
+
+INLINE_INFO = YES
+
+# If the SORT_MEMBER_DOCS tag is set to YES (the default) then doxygen
+# will sort the (detailed) documentation of file and class members
+# alphabetically by member name. If set to NO the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
+
+# If the SORT_BRIEF_DOCS tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# brief documentation of file, namespace and class members alphabetically
+# by member name. If set to NO (the default) the members will appear in
+# declaration order.
+
+SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
+
+# If the SORT_GROUP_NAMES tag is set to YES then doxygen will sort the
+# hierarchy of group names into alphabetical order. If set to NO (the default)
+# the group names will appear in their defined order.
+
+SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
+
+# If the SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME tag is set to YES, the class list will be
+# sorted by fully-qualified names, including namespaces. If set to
+# NO (the default), the class list will be sorted only by class name,
+# not including the namespace part.
+# Note: This option is not very useful if HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES is set to YES.
+# Note: This option applies only to the class list, not to the
+# alphabetical list.
+
+SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TODOLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the todo list. This list is created by putting \todo
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_TESTLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the test list. This list is created by putting \test
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_BUGLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the bug list. This list is created by putting \bug
+# commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
+
+# The GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST tag can be used to enable (YES) or
+# disable (NO) the deprecated list. This list is created by putting
+# \deprecated commands in the documentation.
+
+GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= YES
+
+# The ENABLED_SECTIONS tag can be used to enable conditional
+# documentation sections, marked by \if sectionname ... \endif.
+
+ENABLED_SECTIONS =
+
+# The MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES tag determines the maximum number of lines
+# the initial value of a variable or define consists of for it to appear in
+# the documentation. If the initializer consists of more lines than specified
+# here it will be hidden. Use a value of 0 to hide initializers completely.
+# The appearance of the initializer of individual variables and defines in the
+# documentation can be controlled using \showinitializer or \hideinitializer
+# command in the documentation regardless of this setting.
+
+MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
+
+# Set the SHOW_USED_FILES tag to NO to disable the list of files generated
+# at the bottom of the documentation of classes and structs. If set to YES the
+# list will mention the files that were used to generate the documentation.
+
+SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
+
+# If the sources in your project are distributed over multiple directories
+# then setting the SHOW_DIRECTORIES tag to YES will show the directory hierarchy
+# in the documentation. The default is NO.
+
+SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_FILES tag to NO to disable the generation of the Files page.
+# This will remove the Files entry from the Quick Index and from the
+# Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_FILES = YES
+
+# Set the SHOW_NAMESPACES tag to NO to disable the generation of the
+# Namespaces page. This will remove the Namespaces entry from the Quick Index
+# and from the Folder Tree View (if specified). The default is YES.
+
+SHOW_NAMESPACES = YES
+
+# The FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program or script that
+# doxygen should invoke to get the current version for each file (typically from
+# the version control system). Doxygen will invoke the program by executing (via
+# popen()) the command <command> <input-file>, where <command> is the value of
+# the FILE_VERSION_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an input file
+# provided by doxygen. Whatever the program writes to standard output
+# is used as the file version. See the manual for examples.
+
+FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
+
+# The LAYOUT_FILE tag can be used to specify a layout file which will be parsed by
+# doxygen. The layout file controls the global structure of the generated output files
+# in an output format independent way. The create the layout file that represents
+# doxygen's defaults, run doxygen with the -l option. You can optionally specify a
+# file name after the option, if omitted DoxygenLayout.xml will be used as the name
+# of the layout file.
+
+LAYOUT_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The QUIET tag can be used to turn on/off the messages that are generated
+# by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+QUIET = YES
+
+# The WARNINGS tag can be used to turn on/off the warning messages that are
+# generated by doxygen. Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank
+# NO is used.
+
+WARNINGS = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED is set to YES, then doxygen will generate warnings
+# for undocumented members. If EXTRACT_ALL is set to YES then this flag will
+# automatically be disabled.
+
+WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
+
+# If WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR is set to YES, doxygen will generate warnings for
+# potential errors in the documentation, such as not documenting some
+# parameters in a documented function, or documenting parameters that
+# don't exist or using markup commands wrongly.
+
+WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
+
+# This WARN_NO_PARAMDOC option can be abled to get warnings for
+# functions that are documented, but have no documentation for their parameters
+# or return value. If set to NO (the default) doxygen will only warn about
+# wrong or incomplete parameter documentation, but not about the absence of
+# documentation.
+
+WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = YES
+
+# The WARN_FORMAT tag determines the format of the warning messages that
+# doxygen can produce. The string should contain the $file, $line, and $text
+# tags, which will be replaced by the file and line number from which the
+# warning originated and the warning text. Optionally the format may contain
+# $version, which will be replaced by the version of the file (if it could
+# be obtained via FILE_VERSION_FILTER)
+
+WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
+
+# The WARN_LOGFILE tag can be used to specify a file to which warning
+# and error messages should be written. If left blank the output is written
+# to stderr.
+
+WARN_LOGFILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the input files
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The INPUT tag can be used to specify the files and/or directories that contain
+# documented source files. You may enter file names like "myfile.cpp" or
+# directories like "/usr/src/myproject". Separate the files or directories
+# with spaces.
+
+INPUT = ./
+
+# This tag can be used to specify the character encoding of the source files
+# that doxygen parses. Internally doxygen uses the UTF-8 encoding, which is
+# also the default input encoding. Doxygen uses libiconv (or the iconv built
+# into libc) for the transcoding. See http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv for
+# the list of possible encodings.
+
+INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank the following patterns are tested:
+# *.c *.cc *.cxx *.cpp *.c++ *.java *.ii *.ixx *.ipp *.i++ *.inl *.h *.hh *.hxx
+# *.hpp *.h++ *.idl *.odl *.cs *.php *.php3 *.inc *.m *.mm *.py *.f90
+
+FILE_PATTERNS = *.h \
+ *.c \
+ *.txt
+
+# The RECURSIVE tag can be used to turn specify whether or not subdirectories
+# should be searched for input files as well. Possible values are YES and NO.
+# If left blank NO is used.
+
+RECURSIVE = YES
+
+# The EXCLUDE tag can be used to specify files and/or directories that should
+# excluded from the INPUT source files. This way you can easily exclude a
+# subdirectory from a directory tree whose root is specified with the INPUT tag.
+
+EXCLUDE =
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS tag can be used select whether or not files or
+# directories that are symbolic links (a Unix filesystem feature) are excluded
+# from the input.
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
+
+# If the value of the INPUT tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXCLUDE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard patterns to exclude
+# certain files from those directories. Note that the wildcards are matched
+# against the file with absolute path, so to exclude all test directories
+# for example use the pattern */test/*
+
+EXCLUDE_PATTERNS = */LowLevel/USBMode.h
+
+# The EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS tag can be used to specify one or more symbol names
+# (namespaces, classes, functions, etc.) that should be excluded from the
+# output. The symbol name can be a fully qualified name, a word, or if the
+# wildcard * is used, a substring. Examples: ANamespace, AClass,
+# AClass::ANamespace, ANamespace::*Test
+
+EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = __*
+
+# The EXAMPLE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain example code fragments that are included (see
+# the \include command).
+
+EXAMPLE_PATH =
+
+# If the value of the EXAMPLE_PATH tag contains directories, you can use the
+# EXAMPLE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard pattern (like *.cpp
+# and *.h) to filter out the source-files in the directories. If left
+# blank all files are included.
+
+EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
+
+# If the EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE tag is set to YES then subdirectories will be
+# searched for input files to be used with the \include or \dontinclude
+# commands irrespective of the value of the RECURSIVE tag.
+# Possible values are YES and NO. If left blank NO is used.
+
+EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
+
+# The IMAGE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more files or
+# directories that contain image that are included in the documentation (see
+# the \image command).
+
+IMAGE_PATH =
+
+# The INPUT_FILTER tag can be used to specify a program that doxygen should
+# invoke to filter for each input file. Doxygen will invoke the filter program
+# by executing (via popen()) the command <filter> <input-file>, where <filter>
+# is the value of the INPUT_FILTER tag, and <input-file> is the name of an
+# input file. Doxygen will then use the output that the filter program writes
+# to standard output. If FILTER_PATTERNS is specified, this tag will be
+# ignored.
+
+INPUT_FILTER =
+
+# The FILTER_PATTERNS tag can be used to specify filters on a per file pattern
+# basis. Doxygen will compare the file name with each pattern and apply the
+# filter if there is a match. The filters are a list of the form:
+# pattern=filter (like *.cpp=my_cpp_filter). See INPUT_FILTER for further
+# info on how filters are used. If FILTER_PATTERNS is empty, INPUT_FILTER
+# is applied to all files.
+
+FILTER_PATTERNS =
+
+# If the FILTER_SOURCE_FILES tag is set to YES, the input filter (if set using
+# INPUT_FILTER) will be used to filter the input files when producing source
+# files to browse (i.e. when SOURCE_BROWSER is set to YES).
+
+FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to source browsing
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES then a list of source files will
+# be generated. Documented entities will be cross-referenced with these sources.
+# Note: To get rid of all source code in the generated output, make sure also
+# VERBATIM_HEADERS is set to NO.
+
+SOURCE_BROWSER = NO
+
+# Setting the INLINE_SOURCES tag to YES will include the body
+# of functions and classes directly in the documentation.
+
+INLINE_SOURCES = NO
+
+# Setting the STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS tag to YES (the default) will instruct
+# doxygen to hide any special comment blocks from generated source code
+# fragments. Normal C and C++ comments will always remain visible.
+
+STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
+
+# If the REFERENCED_BY_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented
+# functions referencing it will be listed.
+
+REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_RELATION tag is set to YES
+# then for each documented function all documented entities
+# called/used by that function will be listed.
+
+REFERENCES_RELATION = NO
+
+# If the REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE tag is set to YES (the default)
+# and SOURCE_BROWSER tag is set to YES, then the hyperlinks from
+# functions in REFERENCES_RELATION and REFERENCED_BY_RELATION lists will
+# link to the source code. Otherwise they will link to the documentstion.
+
+REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = NO
+
+# If the USE_HTAGS tag is set to YES then the references to source code
+# will point to the HTML generated by the htags(1) tool instead of doxygen
+# built-in source browser. The htags tool is part of GNU's global source
+# tagging system (see http://www.gnu.org/software/global/global.html). You
+# will need version 4.8.6 or higher.
+
+USE_HTAGS = NO
+
+# If the VERBATIM_HEADERS tag is set to YES (the default) then Doxygen
+# will generate a verbatim copy of the header file for each class for
+# which an include is specified. Set to NO to disable this.
+
+VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ALPHABETICAL_INDEX tag is set to YES, an alphabetical index
+# of all compounds will be generated. Enable this if the project
+# contains a lot of classes, structs, unions or interfaces.
+
+ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
+
+# If the alphabetical index is enabled (see ALPHABETICAL_INDEX) then
+# the COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX tag can be used to specify the number of columns
+# in which this list will be split (can be a number in the range [1..20])
+
+COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
+
+# In case all classes in a project start with a common prefix, all
+# classes will be put under the same header in the alphabetical index.
+# The IGNORE_PREFIX tag can be used to specify one or more prefixes that
+# should be ignored while generating the index headers.
+
+IGNORE_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the HTML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTML tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate HTML output.
+
+GENERATE_HTML = YES
+
+# The HTML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the HTML docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `html' will be used as the default path.
+
+HTML_OUTPUT = html
+
+# The HTML_FILE_EXTENSION tag can be used to specify the file extension for
+# each generated HTML page (for example: .htm,.php,.asp). If it is left blank
+# doxygen will generate files with .html extension.
+
+HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
+
+# The HTML_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML header for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header.
+
+HTML_HEADER =
+
+# The HTML_FOOTER tag can be used to specify a personal HTML footer for
+# each generated HTML page. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard footer.
+
+HTML_FOOTER =
+
+# The HTML_STYLESHEET tag can be used to specify a user-defined cascading
+# style sheet that is used by each HTML page. It can be used to
+# fine-tune the look of the HTML output. If the tag is left blank doxygen
+# will generate a default style sheet. Note that doxygen will try to copy
+# the style sheet file to the HTML output directory, so don't put your own
+# stylesheet in the HTML output directory as well, or it will be erased!
+
+HTML_STYLESHEET =
+
+# If the HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS tag is set to YES, the members of classes,
+# files or namespaces will be aligned in HTML using tables. If set to
+# NO a bullet list will be used.
+
+HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
+
+# If the HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS tag is set to YES then the generated HTML
+# documentation will contain sections that can be hidden and shown after the
+# page has loaded. For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript and DHTML is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+, Firefox
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, Konqueror, or Safari).
+
+HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for Apple's Xcode 3
+# integrated development environment, introduced with OSX 10.5 (Leopard).
+# To create a documentation set, doxygen will generate a Makefile in the
+# HTML output directory. Running make will produce the docset in that
+# directory and running "make install" will install the docset in
+# ~/Library/Developer/Shared/Documentation/DocSets so that Xcode will find
+# it at startup.
+# See http://developer.apple.com/tools/creatingdocsetswithdoxygen.html for more information.
+
+GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag determines the name of the
+# feed. A documentation feed provides an umbrella under which multiple
+# documentation sets from a single provider (such as a company or product suite)
+# can be grouped.
+
+DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
+
+# When GENERATE_DOCSET tag is set to YES, this tag specifies a string that
+# should uniquely identify the documentation set bundle. This should be a
+# reverse domain-name style string, e.g. com.mycompany.MyDocSet. Doxygen
+# will append .docset to the name.
+
+DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, additional index files
+# will be generated that can be used as input for tools like the
+# Microsoft HTML help workshop to generate a compiled HTML help file (.chm)
+# of the generated HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .chm file. You
+# can add a path in front of the file if the result should not be
+# written to the html output directory.
+
+CHM_FILE =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the HHC_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location (absolute path including file name) of
+# the HTML help compiler (hhc.exe). If non-empty doxygen will try to run
+# the HTML help compiler on the generated index.hhp.
+
+HHC_LOCATION =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the GENERATE_CHI flag
+# controls if a separate .chi index file is generated (YES) or that
+# it should be included in the master .chm file (NO).
+
+GENERATE_CHI = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the CHM_INDEX_ENCODING
+# is used to encode HtmlHelp index (hhk), content (hhc) and project file
+# content.
+
+CHM_INDEX_ENCODING =
+
+# If the GENERATE_HTMLHELP tag is set to YES, the BINARY_TOC flag
+# controls whether a binary table of contents is generated (YES) or a
+# normal table of contents (NO) in the .chm file.
+
+BINARY_TOC = NO
+
+# The TOC_EXPAND flag can be set to YES to add extra items for group members
+# to the contents of the HTML help documentation and to the tree view.
+
+TOC_EXPAND = YES
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES and both QHP_NAMESPACE and QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER
+# are set, an additional index file will be generated that can be used as input for
+# Qt's qhelpgenerator to generate a Qt Compressed Help (.qch) of the generated
+# HTML documentation.
+
+GENERATE_QHP = NO
+
+# If the QHG_LOCATION tag is specified, the QCH_FILE tag can
+# be used to specify the file name of the resulting .qch file.
+# The path specified is relative to the HTML output folder.
+
+QCH_FILE =
+
+# The QHP_NAMESPACE tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#namespace">Qt Help Project / Namespace</a>.
+
+QHP_NAMESPACE = org.doxygen.Project
+
+# The QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER tag specifies the namespace to use when generating
+# Qt Help Project output. For more information please see
+# <a href="http://doc.trolltech.com/qthelpproject.html#virtual-folders">Qt Help Project / Virtual Folders</a>.
+
+QHP_VIRTUAL_FOLDER = doc
+
+# If the GENERATE_QHP tag is set to YES, the QHG_LOCATION tag can
+# be used to specify the location of Qt's qhelpgenerator.
+# If non-empty doxygen will try to run qhelpgenerator on the generated
+# .qhp file .
+
+QHG_LOCATION =
+
+# The DISABLE_INDEX tag can be used to turn on/off the condensed index at
+# top of each HTML page. The value NO (the default) enables the index and
+# the value YES disables it.
+
+DISABLE_INDEX = NO
+
+# This tag can be used to set the number of enum values (range [1..20])
+# that doxygen will group on one line in the generated HTML documentation.
+
+ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 1
+
+# The GENERATE_TREEVIEW tag is used to specify whether a tree-like index
+# structure should be generated to display hierarchical information.
+# If the tag value is set to FRAME, a side panel will be generated
+# containing a tree-like index structure (just like the one that
+# is generated for HTML Help). For this to work a browser that supports
+# JavaScript, DHTML, CSS and frames is required (for instance Mozilla 1.0+,
+# Netscape 6.0+, Internet explorer 5.0+, or Konqueror). Windows users are
+# probably better off using the HTML help feature. Other possible values
+# for this tag are: HIERARCHIES, which will generate the Groups, Directories,
+# and Class Hierarchy pages using a tree view instead of an ordered list;
+# ALL, which combines the behavior of FRAME and HIERARCHIES; and NONE, which
+# disables this behavior completely. For backwards compatibility with previous
+# releases of Doxygen, the values YES and NO are equivalent to FRAME and NONE
+# respectively.
+
+GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
+
+# If the treeview is enabled (see GENERATE_TREEVIEW) then this tag can be
+# used to set the initial width (in pixels) of the frame in which the tree
+# is shown.
+
+TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
+
+# Use this tag to change the font size of Latex formulas included
+# as images in the HTML documentation. The default is 10. Note that
+# when you change the font size after a successful doxygen run you need
+# to manually remove any form_*.png images from the HTML output directory
+# to force them to be regenerated.
+
+FORMULA_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_LATEX tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate Latex output.
+
+GENERATE_LATEX = NO
+
+# The LATEX_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the LaTeX docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default path.
+
+LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
+
+# The LATEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the LaTeX command name to be
+# invoked. If left blank `latex' will be used as the default command name.
+
+LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
+
+# The MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME tag can be used to specify the command name to
+# generate index for LaTeX. If left blank `makeindex' will be used as the
+# default command name.
+
+MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
+
+# If the COMPACT_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# LaTeX documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_LATEX = NO
+
+# The PAPER_TYPE tag can be used to set the paper type that is used
+# by the printer. Possible values are: a4, a4wide, letter, legal and
+# executive. If left blank a4wide will be used.
+
+PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
+
+# The EXTRA_PACKAGES tag can be to specify one or more names of LaTeX
+# packages that should be included in the LaTeX output.
+
+EXTRA_PACKAGES =
+
+# The LATEX_HEADER tag can be used to specify a personal LaTeX header for
+# the generated latex document. The header should contain everything until
+# the first chapter. If it is left blank doxygen will generate a
+# standard header. Notice: only use this tag if you know what you are doing!
+
+LATEX_HEADER =
+
+# If the PDF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the LaTeX that is generated
+# is prepared for conversion to pdf (using ps2pdf). The pdf file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using a pdf viewer.
+
+PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
+
+# If the USE_PDFLATEX tag is set to YES, pdflatex will be used instead of
+# plain latex in the generated Makefile. Set this option to YES to get a
+# higher quality PDF documentation.
+
+USE_PDFLATEX = YES
+
+# If the LATEX_BATCHMODE tag is set to YES, doxygen will add the \\batchmode.
+# command to the generated LaTeX files. This will instruct LaTeX to keep
+# running if errors occur, instead of asking the user for help.
+# This option is also used when generating formulas in HTML.
+
+LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
+
+# If LATEX_HIDE_INDICES is set to YES then doxygen will not
+# include the index chapters (such as File Index, Compound Index, etc.)
+# in the output.
+
+LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the RTF output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate RTF output
+# The RTF output is optimized for Word 97 and may not look very pretty with
+# other RTF readers or editors.
+
+GENERATE_RTF = NO
+
+# The RTF_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the RTF docs will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `rtf' will be used as the default path.
+
+RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
+
+# If the COMPACT_RTF tag is set to YES Doxygen generates more compact
+# RTF documents. This may be useful for small projects and may help to
+# save some trees in general.
+
+COMPACT_RTF = NO
+
+# If the RTF_HYPERLINKS tag is set to YES, the RTF that is generated
+# will contain hyperlink fields. The RTF file will
+# contain links (just like the HTML output) instead of page references.
+# This makes the output suitable for online browsing using WORD or other
+# programs which support those fields.
+# Note: wordpad (write) and others do not support links.
+
+RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
+
+# Load stylesheet definitions from file. Syntax is similar to doxygen's
+# config file, i.e. a series of assignments. You only have to provide
+# replacements, missing definitions are set to their default value.
+
+RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
+
+# Set optional variables used in the generation of an rtf document.
+# Syntax is similar to doxygen's config file.
+
+RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the man page output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_MAN tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate man pages
+
+GENERATE_MAN = NO
+
+# The MAN_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the man pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `man' will be used as the default path.
+
+MAN_OUTPUT = man
+
+# The MAN_EXTENSION tag determines the extension that is added to
+# the generated man pages (default is the subroutine's section .3)
+
+MAN_EXTENSION = .3
+
+# If the MAN_LINKS tag is set to YES and Doxygen generates man output,
+# then it will generate one additional man file for each entity
+# documented in the real man page(s). These additional files
+# only source the real man page, but without them the man command
+# would be unable to find the correct page. The default is NO.
+
+MAN_LINKS = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the XML output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_XML tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an XML file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation.
+
+GENERATE_XML = NO
+
+# The XML_OUTPUT tag is used to specify where the XML pages will be put.
+# If a relative path is entered the value of OUTPUT_DIRECTORY will be
+# put in front of it. If left blank `xml' will be used as the default path.
+
+XML_OUTPUT = xml
+
+# The XML_SCHEMA tag can be used to specify an XML schema,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_SCHEMA =
+
+# The XML_DTD tag can be used to specify an XML DTD,
+# which can be used by a validating XML parser to check the
+# syntax of the XML files.
+
+XML_DTD =
+
+# If the XML_PROGRAMLISTING tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# dump the program listings (including syntax highlighting
+# and cross-referencing information) to the XML output. Note that
+# enabling this will significantly increase the size of the XML output.
+
+XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate an AutoGen Definitions (see autogen.sf.net) file
+# that captures the structure of the code including all
+# documentation. Note that this feature is still experimental
+# and incomplete at the moment.
+
+GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# configuration options related to the Perl module output
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the GENERATE_PERLMOD tag is set to YES Doxygen will
+# generate a Perl module file that captures the structure of
+# the code including all documentation. Note that this
+# feature is still experimental and incomplete at the
+# moment.
+
+GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_LATEX tag is set to YES Doxygen will generate
+# the necessary Makefile rules, Perl scripts and LaTeX code to be able
+# to generate PDF and DVI output from the Perl module output.
+
+PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
+
+# If the PERLMOD_PRETTY tag is set to YES the Perl module output will be
+# nicely formatted so it can be parsed by a human reader. This is useful
+# if you want to understand what is going on. On the other hand, if this
+# tag is set to NO the size of the Perl module output will be much smaller
+# and Perl will parse it just the same.
+
+PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
+
+# The names of the make variables in the generated doxyrules.make file
+# are prefixed with the string contained in PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX.
+# This is useful so different doxyrules.make files included by the same
+# Makefile don't overwrite each other's variables.
+
+PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# evaluate all C-preprocessor directives found in the sources and include
+# files.
+
+ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION tag is set to YES Doxygen will expand all macro
+# names in the source code. If set to NO (the default) only conditional
+# compilation will be performed. Macro expansion can be done in a controlled
+# way by setting EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF to YES.
+
+MACRO_EXPANSION = YES
+
+# If the EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF and MACRO_EXPANSION tags are both set to YES
+# then the macro expansion is limited to the macros specified with the
+# PREDEFINED and EXPAND_AS_DEFINED tags.
+
+EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = YES
+
+# If the SEARCH_INCLUDES tag is set to YES (the default) the includes files
+# in the INCLUDE_PATH (see below) will be search if a #include is found.
+
+SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
+
+# The INCLUDE_PATH tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain include files that are not input files but should be processed by
+# the preprocessor.
+
+INCLUDE_PATH =
+
+# You can use the INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS tag to specify one or more wildcard
+# patterns (like *.h and *.hpp) to filter out the header-files in the
+# directories. If left blank, the patterns specified with FILE_PATTERNS will
+# be used.
+
+INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
+
+# The PREDEFINED tag can be used to specify one or more macro names that
+# are defined before the preprocessor is started (similar to the -D option of
+# gcc). The argument of the tag is a list of macros of the form: name
+# or name=definition (no spaces). If the definition and the = are
+# omitted =1 is assumed. To prevent a macro definition from being
+# undefined via #undef or recursively expanded use the := operator
+# instead of the = operator.
+
+PREDEFINED = __DOXYGEN__
+
+# If the MACRO_EXPANSION and EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF tags are set to YES then
+# this tag can be used to specify a list of macro names that should be expanded.
+# The macro definition that is found in the sources will be used.
+# Use the PREDEFINED tag if you want to use a different macro definition.
+
+EXPAND_AS_DEFINED = BUTTLOADTAG
+
+# If the SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS tag is set to YES (the default) then
+# doxygen's preprocessor will remove all function-like macros that are alone
+# on a line, have an all uppercase name, and do not end with a semicolon. Such
+# function macros are typically used for boiler-plate code, and will confuse
+# the parser if not removed.
+
+SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to external references
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The TAGFILES option can be used to specify one or more tagfiles.
+# Optionally an initial location of the external documentation
+# can be added for each tagfile. The format of a tag file without
+# this location is as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1 file2 ...
+# Adding location for the tag files is done as follows:
+# TAGFILES = file1=loc1 "file2 = loc2" ...
+# where "loc1" and "loc2" can be relative or absolute paths or
+# URLs. If a location is present for each tag, the installdox tool
+# does not have to be run to correct the links.
+# Note that each tag file must have a unique name
+# (where the name does NOT include the path)
+# If a tag file is not located in the directory in which doxygen
+# is run, you must also specify the path to the tagfile here.
+
+TAGFILES =
+
+# When a file name is specified after GENERATE_TAGFILE, doxygen will create
+# a tag file that is based on the input files it reads.
+
+GENERATE_TAGFILE =
+
+# If the ALLEXTERNALS tag is set to YES all external classes will be listed
+# in the class index. If set to NO only the inherited external classes
+# will be listed.
+
+ALLEXTERNALS = NO
+
+# If the EXTERNAL_GROUPS tag is set to YES all external groups will be listed
+# in the modules index. If set to NO, only the current project's groups will
+# be listed.
+
+EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
+
+# The PERL_PATH should be the absolute path and name of the perl script
+# interpreter (i.e. the result of `which perl').
+
+PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration options related to the dot tool
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# If the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a inheritance diagram (in HTML, RTF and LaTeX) for classes with base
+# or super classes. Setting the tag to NO turns the diagrams off. Note that
+# this option is superseded by the HAVE_DOT option below. This is only a
+# fallback. It is recommended to install and use dot, since it yields more
+# powerful graphs.
+
+CLASS_DIAGRAMS = NO
+
+# You can define message sequence charts within doxygen comments using the \msc
+# command. Doxygen will then run the mscgen tool (see
+# http://www.mcternan.me.uk/mscgen/) to produce the chart and insert it in the
+# documentation. The MSCGEN_PATH tag allows you to specify the directory where
+# the mscgen tool resides. If left empty the tool is assumed to be found in the
+# default search path.
+
+MSCGEN_PATH =
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will hide
+# inheritance and usage relations if the target is undocumented
+# or is not a class.
+
+HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
+
+# If you set the HAVE_DOT tag to YES then doxygen will assume the dot tool is
+# available from the path. This tool is part of Graphviz, a graph visualization
+# toolkit from AT&T and Lucent Bell Labs. The other options in this section
+# have no effect if this option is set to NO (the default)
+
+HAVE_DOT = NO
+
+# By default doxygen will write a font called FreeSans.ttf to the output
+# directory and reference it in all dot files that doxygen generates. This
+# font does not include all possible unicode characters however, so when you need
+# these (or just want a differently looking font) you can specify the font name
+# using DOT_FONTNAME. You need need to make sure dot is able to find the font,
+# which can be done by putting it in a standard location or by setting the
+# DOTFONTPATH environment variable or by setting DOT_FONTPATH to the directory
+# containing the font.
+
+DOT_FONTNAME = FreeSans
+
+# The DOT_FONTSIZE tag can be used to set the size of the font of dot graphs.
+# The default size is 10pt.
+
+DOT_FONTSIZE = 10
+
+# By default doxygen will tell dot to use the output directory to look for the
+# FreeSans.ttf font (which doxygen will put there itself). If you specify a
+# different font using DOT_FONTNAME you can set the path where dot
+# can find it using this tag.
+
+DOT_FONTPATH =
+
+# If the CLASS_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect inheritance relations. Setting this tag to YES will force the
+# the CLASS_DIAGRAMS tag to NO.
+
+CLASS_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the COLLABORATION_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for each documented class showing the direct and
+# indirect implementation dependencies (inheritance, containment, and
+# class references variables) of the class with other documented classes.
+
+COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GROUP_GRAPHS and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will generate a graph for groups, showing the direct groups dependencies
+
+GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
+
+# If the UML_LOOK tag is set to YES doxygen will generate inheritance and
+# collaboration diagrams in a style similar to the OMG's Unified Modeling
+# Language.
+
+UML_LOOK = NO
+
+# If set to YES, the inheritance and collaboration graphs will show the
+# relations between templates and their instances.
+
+TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDE_GRAPH, and HAVE_DOT
+# tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each documented
+# file showing the direct and indirect include dependencies of the file with
+# other documented files.
+
+INCLUDE_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the ENABLE_PREPROCESSING, SEARCH_INCLUDES, INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH, and
+# HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen will generate a graph for each
+# documented header file showing the documented files that directly or
+# indirectly include this file.
+
+INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALL_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT options are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a call dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable call graphs
+# for selected functions only using the \callgraph command.
+
+CALL_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the CALLER_GRAPH and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then
+# doxygen will generate a caller dependency graph for every global function
+# or class method. Note that enabling this option will significantly increase
+# the time of a run. So in most cases it will be better to enable caller
+# graphs for selected functions only using the \callergraph command.
+
+CALLER_GRAPH = NO
+
+# If the GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES then doxygen
+# will graphical hierarchy of all classes instead of a textual one.
+
+GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
+
+# If the DIRECTORY_GRAPH, SHOW_DIRECTORIES and HAVE_DOT tags are set to YES
+# then doxygen will show the dependencies a directory has on other directories
+# in a graphical way. The dependency relations are determined by the #include
+# relations between the files in the directories.
+
+DIRECTORY_GRAPH = NO
+
+# The DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT tag can be used to set the image format of the images
+# generated by dot. Possible values are png, jpg, or gif
+# If left blank png will be used.
+
+DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
+
+# The tag DOT_PATH can be used to specify the path where the dot tool can be
+# found. If left blank, it is assumed the dot tool can be found in the path.
+
+DOT_PATH = "C:/Program Files/Graphviz2.18/bin"
+
+# The DOTFILE_DIRS tag can be used to specify one or more directories that
+# contain dot files that are included in the documentation (see the
+# \dotfile command).
+
+DOTFILE_DIRS =
+
+# The DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES tag can be used to set the maximum number of
+# nodes that will be shown in the graph. If the number of nodes in a graph
+# becomes larger than this value, doxygen will truncate the graph, which is
+# visualized by representing a node as a red box. Note that doxygen if the
+# number of direct children of the root node in a graph is already larger than
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES then the graph will not be shown at all. Also note
+# that the size of a graph can be further restricted by MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH.
+
+DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 15
+
+# The MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH tag can be used to set the maximum depth of the
+# graphs generated by dot. A depth value of 3 means that only nodes reachable
+# from the root by following a path via at most 3 edges will be shown. Nodes
+# that lay further from the root node will be omitted. Note that setting this
+# option to 1 or 2 may greatly reduce the computation time needed for large
+# code bases. Also note that the size of a graph can be further restricted by
+# DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES. Using a depth of 0 means no depth restriction.
+
+MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
+
+# Set the DOT_TRANSPARENT tag to YES to generate images with a transparent
+# background. This is disabled by default, because dot on Windows does not
+# seem to support this out of the box. Warning: Depending on the platform used,
+# enabling this option may lead to badly anti-aliased labels on the edges of
+# a graph (i.e. they become hard to read).
+
+DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
+
+# Set the DOT_MULTI_TARGETS tag to YES allow dot to generate multiple output
+# files in one run (i.e. multiple -o and -T options on the command line). This
+# makes dot run faster, but since only newer versions of dot (>1.8.10)
+# support this, this feature is disabled by default.
+
+DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
+
+# If the GENERATE_LEGEND tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# generate a legend page explaining the meaning of the various boxes and
+# arrows in the dot generated graphs.
+
+GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
+
+# If the DOT_CLEANUP tag is set to YES (the default) Doxygen will
+# remove the intermediate dot files that are used to generate
+# the various graphs.
+
+DOT_CLEANUP = YES
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+# The SEARCHENGINE tag specifies whether or not a search engine should be
+# used. If set to NO the values of all tags below this one will be ignored.
+
+SEARCHENGINE = NO
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/makefile b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/makefile
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..7569ea24
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioInput/makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,702 @@
+# Hey Emacs, this is a -*- makefile -*-
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# WinAVR Makefile Template written by Eric B. Weddington, Jörg Wunsch, et al.
+# >> Modified for use with the LUFA project. <<
+#
+# Released to the Public Domain
+#
+# Additional material for this makefile was written by:
+# Peter Fleury
+# Tim Henigan
+# Colin O'Flynn
+# Reiner Patommel
+# Markus Pfaff
+# Sander Pool
+# Frederik Rouleau
+# Carlos Lamas
+# Dean Camera
+# Opendous Inc.
+#
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# On command line:
+#
+# make all = Make software.
+#
+# make clean = Clean out built project files.
+#
+# make coff = Convert ELF to AVR COFF.
+#
+# make extcoff = Convert ELF to AVR Extended COFF.
+#
+# make program = Download the hex file to the device, using avrdude.
+# Please customize the avrdude settings below first!
+#
+# make dfu = Download the hex file to the device, using dfu-programmer (must
+# have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip = Download the hex file to the device, using Atmel FLIP (must
+# have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make dfu-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using dfu-programmer
+# (must have dfu-programmer installed).
+#
+# make flip-ee = Download the eeprom file to the device, using Atmel FLIP
+# (must have Atmel FLIP installed).
+#
+# make doxygen = Generate DoxyGen documentation for the project (must have
+# DoxyGen installed)
+#
+# make debug = Start either simulavr or avarice as specified for debugging,
+# with avr-gdb or avr-insight as the front end for debugging.
+#
+# make filename.s = Just compile filename.c into the assembler code only.
+#
+# make filename.i = Create a preprocessed source file for use in submitting
+# bug reports to the GCC project.
+#
+# To rebuild project do "make clean" then "make all".
+#----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+# MCU name
+MCU = at90usb1287
+
+
+# Target board (see library BoardTypes.h documentation, USER or blank for projects not requiring
+# LUFA board drivers). If USER is selected, put custom board drivers in a directory called
+# "Board" inside the application directory.
+BOARD = USBKEY
+
+
+# Processor frequency.
+# This will define a symbol, F_CPU, in all source code files equal to the
+# processor frequency. You can then use this symbol in your source code to
+# calculate timings. Do NOT tack on a 'UL' at the end, this will be done
+# automatically to create a 32-bit value in your source code.
+# Typical values are:
+# F_CPU = 1000000
+# F_CPU = 1843200
+# F_CPU = 2000000
+# F_CPU = 3686400
+# F_CPU = 4000000
+# F_CPU = 7372800
+# F_CPU = 8000000
+# F_CPU = 11059200
+# F_CPU = 14745600
+# F_CPU = 16000000
+# F_CPU = 18432000
+# F_CPU = 20000000
+F_CPU = 8000000
+
+
+# Output format. (can be srec, ihex, binary)
+FORMAT = ihex
+
+
+# Target file name (without extension).
+TARGET = AudioInput
+
+
+# Object files directory
+# To put object files in current directory, use a dot (.), do NOT make
+# this an empty or blank macro!
+OBJDIR = .
+
+
+# List C source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+SRC = $(TARGET).c \
+ Descriptors.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Scheduler/Scheduler.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/LowLevel.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/Endpoint.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/LowLevel/DevChapter9.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBTask.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/USBInterrupt.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/Events.c \
+ ../../LUFA/Drivers/USB/HighLevel/StdDescriptors.c \
+
+# List C++ source files here. (C dependencies are automatically generated.)
+CPPSRC =
+
+
+# List Assembler source files here.
+# Make them always end in a capital .S. Files ending in a lowercase .s
+# will not be considered source files but generated files (assembler
+# output from the compiler), and will be deleted upon "make clean"!
+# Even though the DOS/Win* filesystem matches both .s and .S the same,
+# it will preserve the spelling of the filenames, and gcc itself does
+# care about how the name is spelled on its command-line.
+ASRC =
+
+
+# Optimization level, can be [0, 1, 2, 3, s].
+# 0 = turn off optimization. s = optimize for size.
+# (Note: 3 is not always the best optimization level. See avr-libc FAQ.)
+OPT = s
+
+
+# Debugging format.
+# Native formats for AVR-GCC's -g are dwarf-2 [default] or stabs.
+# AVR Studio 4.10 requires dwarf-2.
+# AVR [Extended] COFF format requires stabs, plus an avr-objcopy run.
+DEBUG = dwarf-2
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for include files here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRAINCDIRS = ../../
+
+
+# Compiler flag to set the C Standard level.
+# c89 = "ANSI" C
+# gnu89 = c89 plus GCC extensions
+# c99 = ISO C99 standard (not yet fully implemented)
+# gnu99 = c99 plus GCC extensions
+CSTANDARD = -std=gnu99
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C sources
+CDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL -DBOARD=BOARD_$(BOARD) -DUSE_NONSTANDARD_DESCRIPTOR_NAMES -DNO_STREAM_CALLBACKS
+CDEFS += -DUSB_DEVICE_ONLY -DUSE_STATIC_OPTIONS="(USB_DEVICE_OPT_FULLSPEED | USB_OPT_REG_ENABLED | USB_OPT_AUTO_PLL)"
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for ASM sources
+ADEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)
+
+
+# Place -D or -U options here for C++ sources
+CPPDEFS = -DF_CPU=$(F_CPU)UL
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_LIMIT_MACROS
+#CPPDEFS += -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CFLAGS += $(CDEFS)
+CFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CFLAGS += -ffunction-sections
+CFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CFLAGS += -finline-limit=20
+CFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+CFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Compiler Options C++ ----------------
+# -g*: generate debugging information
+# -O*: optimization level
+# -f...: tuning, see GCC manual and avr-libc documentation
+# -Wall...: warning level
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns...: create assembler listing
+CPPFLAGS = -g$(DEBUG)
+CPPFLAGS += $(CPPDEFS)
+CPPFLAGS += -O$(OPT)
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-char
+CPPFLAGS += -funsigned-bitfields
+CPPFLAGS += -fpack-struct
+CPPFLAGS += -fshort-enums
+CPPFLAGS += -fno-exceptions
+CPPFLAGS += -Wall
+CFLAGS += -Wundef
+#CPPFLAGS += -mshort-calls
+#CPPFLAGS += -fno-unit-at-a-time
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wstrict-prototypes
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wunreachable-code
+#CPPFLAGS += -Wsign-compare
+CPPFLAGS += -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+CPPFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-I%,$(EXTRAINCDIRS))
+#CPPFLAGS += $(CSTANDARD)
+
+
+#---------------- Assembler Options ----------------
+# -Wa,...: tell GCC to pass this to the assembler.
+# -adhlns: create listing
+# -gstabs: have the assembler create line number information; note that
+# for use in COFF files, additional information about filenames
+# and function names needs to be present in the assembler source
+# files -- see avr-libc docs [FIXME: not yet described there]
+# -listing-cont-lines: Sets the maximum number of continuation lines of hex
+# dump that will be displayed for a given single line of source input.
+ASFLAGS = $(ADEFS) -Wa,-adhlns=$(<:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst),-gstabs,--listing-cont-lines=100
+
+
+#---------------- Library Options ----------------
+# Minimalistic printf version
+PRINTF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_min
+
+# Floating point printf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfprintf -lprintf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard printf version.
+PRINTF_LIB =
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_MIN)
+#PRINTF_LIB = $(PRINTF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+# Minimalistic scanf version
+SCANF_LIB_MIN = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_min
+
+# Floating point + %[ scanf version (requires MATH_LIB = -lm below)
+SCANF_LIB_FLOAT = -Wl,-u,vfscanf -lscanf_flt
+
+# If this is left blank, then it will use the Standard scanf version.
+SCANF_LIB =
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_MIN)
+#SCANF_LIB = $(SCANF_LIB_FLOAT)
+
+
+MATH_LIB = -lm
+
+
+# List any extra directories to look for libraries here.
+# Each directory must be seperated by a space.
+# Use forward slashes for directory separators.
+# For a directory that has spaces, enclose it in quotes.
+EXTRALIBDIRS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- External Memory Options ----------------
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# used for variables (.data/.bss) and heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,-Tdata=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+# 64 KB of external RAM, starting after internal RAM (ATmega128!),
+# only used for heap (malloc()).
+#EXTMEMOPTS = -Wl,--section-start,.data=0x801100,--defsym=__heap_end=0x80ffff
+
+EXTMEMOPTS =
+
+
+
+#---------------- Linker Options ----------------
+# -Wl,...: tell GCC to pass this to linker.
+# -Map: create map file
+# --cref: add cross reference to map file
+LDFLAGS = -Wl,-Map=$(TARGET).map,--cref
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--relax
+LDFLAGS += -Wl,--gc-sections
+LDFLAGS += $(EXTMEMOPTS)
+LDFLAGS += $(patsubst %,-L%,$(EXTRALIBDIRS))
+LDFLAGS += $(PRINTF_LIB) $(SCANF_LIB) $(MATH_LIB)
+#LDFLAGS += -T linker_script.x
+
+
+
+#---------------- Programming Options (avrdude) ----------------
+
+# Programming hardware: alf avr910 avrisp bascom bsd
+# dt006 pavr picoweb pony-stk200 sp12 stk200 stk500
+#
+# Type: avrdude -c ?
+# to get a full listing.
+#
+AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER = jtagmkII
+
+# com1 = serial port. Use lpt1 to connect to parallel port.
+AVRDUDE_PORT = usb
+
+AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH = -U flash:w:$(TARGET).hex
+#AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM = -U eeprom:w:$(TARGET).eep
+
+
+# Uncomment the following if you want avrdude's erase cycle counter.
+# Note that this counter needs to be initialized first using -Yn,
+# see avrdude manual.
+#AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER = -y
+
+# Uncomment the following if you do /not/ wish a verification to be
+# performed after programming the device.
+#AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY = -V
+
+# Increase verbosity level. Please use this when submitting bug
+# reports about avrdude. See <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/avrdude>
+# to submit bug reports.
+#AVRDUDE_VERBOSE = -v -v
+
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS = -p $(MCU) -P $(AVRDUDE_PORT) -c $(AVRDUDE_PROGRAMMER)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_NO_VERIFY)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_VERBOSE)
+AVRDUDE_FLAGS += $(AVRDUDE_ERASE_COUNTER)
+
+
+
+#---------------- Debugging Options ----------------
+
+# For simulavr only - target MCU frequency.
+DEBUG_MFREQ = $(F_CPU)
+
+# Set the DEBUG_UI to either gdb or insight.
+# DEBUG_UI = gdb
+DEBUG_UI = insight
+
+# Set the debugging back-end to either avarice, simulavr.
+DEBUG_BACKEND = avarice
+#DEBUG_BACKEND = simulavr
+
+# GDB Init Filename.
+GDBINIT_FILE = __avr_gdbinit
+
+# When using avarice settings for the JTAG
+JTAG_DEV = /dev/com1
+
+# Debugging port used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr.
+DEBUG_PORT = 4242
+
+# Debugging host used to communicate between GDB / avarice / simulavr, normally
+# just set to localhost unless doing some sort of crazy debugging when
+# avarice is running on a different computer.
+DEBUG_HOST = localhost
+
+
+
+#============================================================================
+
+
+# Define programs and commands.
+SHELL = sh
+CC = avr-gcc
+OBJCOPY = avr-objcopy
+OBJDUMP = avr-objdump
+SIZE = avr-size
+AR = avr-ar rcs
+NM = avr-nm
+AVRDUDE = avrdude
+REMOVE = rm -f
+REMOVEDIR = rm -rf
+COPY = cp
+WINSHELL = cmd
+
+# Define Messages
+# English
+MSG_ERRORS_NONE = Errors: none
+MSG_BEGIN = -------- begin --------
+MSG_END = -------- end --------
+MSG_SIZE_BEFORE = Size before:
+MSG_SIZE_AFTER = Size after:
+MSG_COFF = Converting to AVR COFF:
+MSG_EXTENDED_COFF = Converting to AVR Extended COFF:
+MSG_FLASH = Creating load file for Flash:
+MSG_EEPROM = Creating load file for EEPROM:
+MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING = Creating Extended Listing:
+MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE = Creating Symbol Table:
+MSG_LINKING = Linking:
+MSG_COMPILING = Compiling C:
+MSG_COMPILING_CPP = Compiling C++:
+MSG_ASSEMBLING = Assembling:
+MSG_CLEANING = Cleaning project:
+MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY = Creating library:
+
+
+
+
+# Define all object files.
+OBJ = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.o) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+
+# Define all listing files.
+LST = $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(CPPSRC:%.cpp=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst) $(ASRC:%.S=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+
+
+# Compiler flags to generate dependency files.
+GENDEPFLAGS = -MMD -MP -MF .dep/$(@F).d
+
+
+# Combine all necessary flags and optional flags.
+# Add target processor to flags.
+ALL_CFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_CPPFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x c++ $(CPPFLAGS) $(GENDEPFLAGS)
+ALL_ASFLAGS = -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. -x assembler-with-cpp $(ASFLAGS)
+
+
+
+
+
+# Default target.
+all: begin gccversion sizebefore build checkhooks checklibmode sizeafter end
+
+# Change the build target to build a HEX file or a library.
+build: elf hex eep lss sym
+#build: lib
+
+
+elf: $(TARGET).elf
+hex: $(TARGET).hex
+eep: $(TARGET).eep
+lss: $(TARGET).lss
+sym: $(TARGET).sym
+LIBNAME=lib$(TARGET).a
+lib: $(LIBNAME)
+
+
+
+# Eye candy.
+# AVR Studio 3.x does not check make's exit code but relies on
+# the following magic strings to be generated by the compile job.
+begin:
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_BEGIN)
+
+end:
+ @echo $(MSG_END)
+ @echo
+
+
+# Display size of file.
+HEXSIZE = $(SIZE) --target=$(FORMAT) $(TARGET).hex
+ELFSIZE = $(SIZE) --mcu=$(MCU) --format=avr $(TARGET).elf
+
+sizebefore:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_BEFORE); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+sizeafter:
+ @if test -f $(TARGET).elf; then echo; echo $(MSG_SIZE_AFTER); $(ELFSIZE); \
+ 2>/dev/null; echo; fi
+
+checkhooks: build
+ @echo
+ @echo ------- Unhooked LUFA Events -------
+ @$(shell) (grep -s '^Event.*LUFA/.*\\.o' $(TARGET).map | \
+ cut -d' ' -f1 | cut -d'_' -f2- | grep ".*") || \
+ echo "(None)"
+ @echo ----- End Unhooked LUFA Events -----
+
+checklibmode:
+ @echo
+ @echo ----------- Library Mode -----------
+ @$(shell) ($(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) -E -dM - < /dev/null \
+ | grep 'USB_\(DEVICE\|HOST\)_ONLY' | cut -d' ' -f2 | grep ".*") \
+ || echo "No specific mode (both device and host mode allowable)."
+ @echo ------------------------------------
+
+# Display compiler version information.
+gccversion :
+ @$(CC) --version
+
+
+
+# Program the device.
+program: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ $(AVRDUDE) $(AVRDUDE_FLAGS) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_FLASH) $(AVRDUDE_WRITE_EEPROM)
+
+flip: $(TARGET).hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation erase f
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu: $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+flip-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ mv $(TARGET).eep $(TARGET)eep.hex
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM erase F memory FLASH erase F
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation memory EEPROM
+ loadbuffer $(TARGET)eep.hex memory FLASH loadbuffer $(TARGET).hex
+ program
+ batchisp -hardware usb -device $(MCU) -operation start reset 0
+
+dfu-ee: $(TARGET).hex $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) erase
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) flash --debug 1 $(TARGET).hex
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) eeprom --debug 1 $(TARGET).eep
+ dfu-programmer $(MCU) reset
+
+# Generate avr-gdb config/init file which does the following:
+# define the reset signal, load the target file, connect to target, and set
+# a breakpoint at main().
+gdb-config:
+ @$(REMOVE) $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo define reset >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo SIGNAL SIGHUP >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo end >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo file $(TARGET).elf >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ @echo target remote $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT) >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND),simulavr)
+ @echo load >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+endif
+ @echo break main >> $(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+debug: gdb-config $(TARGET).elf
+ifeq ($(DEBUG_BACKEND), avarice)
+ @echo Starting AVaRICE - Press enter when "waiting to connect" message displays.
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avarice --jtag $(JTAG_DEV) --erase --program --file \
+ $(TARGET).elf $(DEBUG_HOST):$(DEBUG_PORT)
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c pause
+
+else
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start simulavr --gdbserver --device $(MCU) --clock-freq \
+ $(DEBUG_MFREQ) --port $(DEBUG_PORT)
+endif
+ @$(WINSHELL) /c start avr-$(DEBUG_UI) --command=$(GDBINIT_FILE)
+
+
+
+
+# Convert ELF to COFF for use in debugging / simulating in AVR Studio or VMLAB.
+COFFCONVERT = $(OBJCOPY) --debugging
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .data-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .bss-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .noinit-0x800000
+COFFCONVERT += --change-section-address .eeprom-0x810000
+
+
+
+coff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+extcoff: $(TARGET).elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_COFF) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(COFFCONVERT) -O coff-ext-avr $< $(TARGET).cof
+
+
+
+# Create final output files (.hex, .eep) from ELF output file.
+%.hex: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_FLASH) $@
+ $(OBJCOPY) -O $(FORMAT) -R .eeprom $< $@
+
+%.eep: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EEPROM) $@
+ -$(OBJCOPY) -j .eeprom --set-section-flags=.eeprom="alloc,load" \
+ --change-section-lma .eeprom=0 --no-change-warnings -O $(FORMAT) $< $@ || exit 0
+
+# Create extended listing file from ELF output file.
+%.lss: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_EXTENDED_LISTING) $@
+ $(OBJDUMP) -h -z -S $< > $@
+
+# Create a symbol table from ELF output file.
+%.sym: %.elf
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_SYMBOL_TABLE) $@
+ $(NM) -n $< > $@
+
+
+
+# Create library from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).a
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.a: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_CREATING_LIBRARY) $@
+ $(AR) $@ $(OBJ)
+
+
+# Link: create ELF output file from object files.
+.SECONDARY : $(TARGET).elf
+.PRECIOUS : $(OBJ)
+%.elf: $(OBJ)
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_LINKING) $@
+ $(CC) $(ALL_CFLAGS) $^ --output $@ $(LDFLAGS)
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.c
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create object files from C++ source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.cpp
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_COMPILING_CPP) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C source files.
+%.s : %.c
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Compile: create assembler files from C++ source files.
+%.s : %.cpp
+ $(CC) -S $(ALL_CPPFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Assemble: create object files from assembler source files.
+$(OBJDIR)/%.o : %.S
+ @echo
+ @echo $(MSG_ASSEMBLING) $<
+ $(CC) -c $(ALL_ASFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Create preprocessed source for use in sending a bug report.
+%.i : %.c
+ $(CC) -E -mmcu=$(MCU) -I. $(CFLAGS) $< -o $@
+
+
+# Target: clean project.
+clean: begin clean_list clean_binary end
+
+clean_binary:
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).hex
+
+clean_list:
+ @echo $(MSG_CLEANING)
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).eep
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).cof
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).elf
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).map
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).sym
+ $(REMOVE) $(TARGET).lss
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.o)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:%.c=$(OBJDIR)/%.lst)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.s)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.d)
+ $(REMOVE) $(SRC:.c=.i)
+ $(REMOVEDIR) .dep
+
+
+doxygen:
+ @echo Generating Project Documentation...
+ @doxygen Doxygen.conf
+ @echo Documentation Generation Complete.
+
+clean_doxygen:
+ rm -rf Documentation
+
+# Create object files directory
+$(shell mkdir $(OBJDIR) 2>/dev/null)
+
+
+# Include the dependency files.
+-include $(shell mkdir .dep 2>/dev/null) $(wildcard .dep/*)
+
+
+# Listing of phony targets.
+.PHONY : all checkhooks checklibmode begin \
+finish end sizebefore sizeafter gccversion \
+build elf hex eep lss sym coff extcoff \
+clean clean_list clean_binary program debug \
+gdb-config doxygen dfu flip
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.aps b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.aps
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a01ba8f1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.aps
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+<AVRStudio><MANAGEMENT><ProjectName>AudioOutput</ProjectName><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:03:51</Created><LastEdit>30-Sep-2008 14:04:06</LastEdit><ICON>241</ICON><ProjectType>0</ProjectType><Created>30-Sep-2008 14:03:51</Created><Version>4</Version><Build>4, 14, 0, 589</Build><ProjectTypeName>AVR GCC</ProjectTypeName></MANAGEMENT><CODE_CREATION><ObjectFile></ObjectFile><EntryFile></EntryFile><SaveFolder>C:\Users\Dean\Documents\Electronics\Projects\WORK\MyUSBWORK\Demos\AudioOutput\</SaveFolder></CODE_CREATION><DEBUG_TARGET><CURRENT_TARGET></CURRENT_TARGET><CURRENT_PART></CURRENT_PART><BREAKPOINTS></BREAKPOINTS><IO_EXPAND><HIDE>false</HIDE></IO_EXPAND><REGISTERNAMES><Register>R00</Register><Register>R01</Register><Register>R02</Register><Register>R03</Register><Register>R04</Register><Register>R05</Register><Register>R06</Register><Register>R07</Register><Register>R08</Register><Register>R09</Register><Register>R10</Register><Register>R11</Register><Register>R12</Register><Register>R13</Register><Register>R14</Register><Register>R15</Register><Register>R16</Register><Register>R17</Register><Register>R18</Register><Register>R19</Register><Register>R20</Register><Register>R21</Register><Register>R22</Register><Register>R23</Register><Register>R24</Register><Register>R25</Register><Register>R26</Register><Register>R27</Register><Register>R28</Register><Register>R29</Register><Register>R30</Register><Register>R31</Register></REGISTERNAMES><COM></COM><COMType>0</COMType><WATCHNUM>0</WATCHNUM><WATCHNAMES><Pane0></Pane0><Pane1></Pane1><Pane2></Pane2><Pane3></Pane3></WATCHNAMES><BreakOnTrcaeFull>0</BreakOnTrcaeFull></DEBUG_TARGET><Debugger><Triggers></Triggers></Debugger><AVRGCCPLUGIN><FILES><SOURCEFILE>AudioOutput.c</SOURCEFILE><SOURCEFILE>Descriptors.c</SOURCEFILE><HEADERFILE>AudioOutput.h</HEADERFILE><HEADERFILE>Descriptors.h</HEADERFILE><OTHERFILE>makefile</OTHERFILE></FILES><CONFIGS><CONFIG><NAME>default</NAME><USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE>YES</USESEXTERNALMAKEFILE><EXTERNALMAKEFILE>makefile</EXTERNALMAKEFILE><PART>atmega128</PART><HEX>1</HEX><LIST>1</LIST><MAP>1</MAP><OUTPUTFILENAME>AudioOutput.elf</OUTPUTFILENAME><OUTPUTDIR>default\</OUTPUTDIR><ISDIRTY>1</ISDIRTY><OPTIONS/><INCDIRS/><LIBDIRS/><LIBS/><LINKOBJECTS/><OPTIONSFORALL>-Wall -gdwarf-2 -std=gnu99 -Os -funsigned-char -funsigned-bitfields -fpack-struct -fshort-enums</OPTIONSFORALL><LINKEROPTIONS></LINKEROPTIONS><SEGMENTS/></CONFIG></CONFIGS><LASTCONFIG>default</LASTCONFIG><USES_WINAVR>1</USES_WINAVR><GCC_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\bin\avr-gcc.exe</GCC_LOC><MAKE_LOC>C:\WinAVR-20080512\utils\bin\make.exe</MAKE_LOC></AVRGCCPLUGIN><IOView><usergroups/><sort sorted="0" column="0" ordername="0" orderaddress="0" ordergroup="0"/></IOView><Files></Files><Events><Bookmarks></Bookmarks></Events><Trace><Filters></Filters></Trace></AVRStudio>
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..184910e8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.c
@@ -0,0 +1,305 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+
+/*
+ Copyright 2009 Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com)
+
+ Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software
+ and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby
+ granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all
+ copies and that both that the copyright notice and this
+ permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting
+ documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in
+ advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
+ software without specific, written prior permission.
+
+ The author disclaim all warranties with regard to this
+ software, including all implied warranties of merchantability
+ and fitness. In no event shall the author be liable for any
+ special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages
+ whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether
+ in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action,
+ arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of
+ this software.
+*/
+
+/** \file
+ *
+ * Main source file for the Audio Output demo. This file contains the main tasks of the demo and
+ * is responsible for the initial application hardware configuration.
+ */
+
+/* --- Project Configuration (Choose ONE) --- */
+//#define AUDIO_OUT_MONO
+#define AUDIO_OUT_STEREO
+//#define AUDIO_OUT_LEDS
+//#define AUDIO_OUT_PORTC
+/* --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- */
+
+#include "AudioOutput.h"
+
+/* Project Tags, for reading out using the ButtLoad project */
+BUTTLOADTAG(ProjName, "LUFA AudioOut App");
+BUTTLOADTAG(BuildTime, __TIME__);
+BUTTLOADTAG(BuildDate, __DATE__);
+BUTTLOADTAG(LUFAVersion, "LUFA V" LUFA_VERSION_STRING);
+
+/* Scheduler Task List */
+TASK_LIST
+{
+ { Task: USB_USBTask , TaskStatus: TASK_STOP },
+ { Task: USB_Audio_Task , TaskStatus: TASK_STOP },
+};
+
+
+/** Main program entry point. This routine configures the hardware required by the application, then
+ * starts the scheduler to run the application tasks.
+ */
+int main(void)
+{
+ /* Disable watchdog if enabled by bootloader/fuses */
+ MCUSR &= ~(1 << WDRF);
+ wdt_disable();
+
+ /* Disable Clock Division */
+ SetSystemClockPrescaler(0);
+
+ /* Hardware Initialization */
+ LEDs_Init();
+
+ /* Indicate USB not ready */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBNotReady);
+
+ /* Initialize Scheduler so that it can be used */
+ Scheduler_Init();
+
+ /* Initialize USB Subsystem */
+ USB_Init();
+
+ /* Scheduling - routine never returns, so put this last in the main function */
+ Scheduler_Start();
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Connect event. This indicates that the device is enumerating via the status LEDs, and
+ * configures the sample update and PWM timers.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Connect)
+{
+ /* Start USB management task */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_USBTask, TASK_RUN);
+
+ /* Indicate USB enumerating */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBEnumerating);
+
+ /* Sample reload timer initialization */
+ OCR0A = (F_CPU / AUDIO_SAMPLE_FREQUENCY);
+ TCCR0A = (1 << WGM01); // CTC mode
+ TCCR0B = (1 << CS00); // Fcpu speed
+
+#if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO)
+ /* Set speaker as output */
+ DDRC |= (1 << 6);
+#elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO)
+ /* Set speakers as outputs */
+ DDRC |= ((1 << 6) | (1 << 5));
+#elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC)
+ /* Set PORTC as outputs */
+ DDRC |= 0xFF;
+#endif
+
+#if (defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) || defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO))
+ /* PWM speaker timer initialization */
+ TCCRxA = ((1 << WGMx0) | (1 << COMxA1) | (1 << COMxA0)
+ | (1 << COMxB1) | (1 << COMxB0)); // Set on match, clear on TOP
+ TCCRxB = ((1 << WGMx2) | (1 << CSx0)); // Fast 8-Bit PWM, Fcpu speed
+#endif
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_Disconnect event. This indicates that the device is no longer connected to a host via
+ * the status LEDs, disables the sample update and PWM output timers and stops the USB and Audio management tasks.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_Disconnect)
+{
+ /* Stop the timers */
+ TCCR0B = 0;
+#if (defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO) || defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO))
+ TCCRxB = 0;
+#endif
+
+#if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO)
+ /* Set speaker as input to reduce current draw */
+ DDRC &= ~(1 << 6);
+#elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO)
+ /* Set speakers as inputs to reduce current draw */
+ DDRC &= ~((1 << 6) | (1 << 5));
+#elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC)
+ /* Set PORTC low */
+ PORTC = 0x00;
+#endif
+
+ /* Stop running audio and USB management tasks */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_Audio_Task, TASK_STOP);
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_USBTask, TASK_STOP);
+
+ /* Indicate USB not ready */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBNotReady);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_ConfigurationChanged event. This is fired when the host set the current configuration
+ * of the USB device after enumeration - the device endpoints are configured.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_ConfigurationChanged)
+{
+ /* Setup audio stream endpoint */
+ Endpoint_ConfigureEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM, EP_TYPE_ISOCHRONOUS,
+ ENDPOINT_DIR_OUT, AUDIO_STREAM_EPSIZE,
+ ENDPOINT_BANK_DOUBLE);
+
+ /* Indicate USB connected and ready */
+ UpdateStatus(Status_USBReady);
+}
+
+/** Event handler for the USB_UnhandledControlPacket event. This is used to catch standard and class specific
+ * control requests that are not handled internally by the USB library (including the Audio class-specific
+ * requests) so that they can be handled appropriately for the application.
+ */
+EVENT_HANDLER(USB_UnhandledControlPacket)
+{
+ /* Process General and Audio specific control requests */
+ switch (bRequest)
+ {
+ case REQ_SetInterface:
+ /* Set Interface is not handled by the library, as its function is application-specific */
+ if (bmRequestType == (REQDIR_HOSTTODEVICE | REQTYPE_STANDARD | REQREC_INTERFACE))
+ {
+ uint16_t wValue = Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupReceived();
+
+ /* Check if the host is enabling the audio interface (setting AlternateSetting to 1) */
+ if (wValue)
+ {
+ /* Start audio task */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_Audio_Task, TASK_RUN);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Stop audio task */
+ Scheduler_SetTaskMode(USB_Audio_Task, TASK_STOP);
+ }
+
+ /* Handshake the request */
+ Endpoint_ClearSetupIN();
+ }
+
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/** Function to manage status updates to the user. This is done via LEDs on the given board, if available, but may be changed to
+ * log to a serial port, or anything else that is suitable for status updates.
+ *
+ * \param CurrentStatus Current status of the system, from the AudioOutput_StatusCodes_t enum
+ */
+void UpdateStatus(uint8_t CurrentStatus)
+{
+ uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS;
+
+ /* Set the LED mask to the appropriate LED mask based on the given status code */
+ switch (CurrentStatus)
+ {
+ case Status_USBNotReady:
+ LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1);
+ break;
+ case Status_USBEnumerating:
+ LEDMask = (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2);
+ break;
+ case Status_USBReady:
+ LEDMask = (LEDS_LED2 | LEDS_LED4);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Set the board LEDs to the new LED mask */
+ LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask);
+}
+
+/** Task to manage the Audio interface, reading in audio samples from the host, and outputting them to the speakers/LEDs as
+ * desired.
+ */
+TASK(USB_Audio_Task)
+{
+ /* Select the audio stream endpoint */
+ Endpoint_SelectEndpoint(AUDIO_STREAM_EPNUM);
+
+ /* Check if the current endpoint can be read from (contains a packet) and that the next sample should be read */
+ if (Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed() && (TIFR0 & (1 << OCF0A)))
+ {
+ /* Clear the sample reload timer */
+ TIFR0 |= (1 << OCF0A);
+
+ /* Retreive the signed 16-bit left and right audio samples */
+ int16_t LeftSample_16Bit = (int16_t)Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+ int16_t RightSample_16Bit = (int16_t)Endpoint_Read_Word_LE();
+
+ /* Check to see if the bank is now empty */
+ if (!(Endpoint_ReadWriteAllowed()))
+ {
+ /* Acknowedge the packet, clear the bank ready for the next packet */
+ Endpoint_ClearCurrentBank();
+ }
+
+ /* Massage signed 16-bit left and right audio samples into signed 8-bit */
+ int8_t LeftSample_8Bit = (LeftSample_16Bit >> 8);
+ int8_t RightSample_8Bit = (RightSample_16Bit >> 8);
+
+#if defined(AUDIO_OUT_MONO)
+ /* Mix the two channels together to produce a mono, 8-bit sample */
+ int8_t MixedSample_8Bit = (((int16_t)LeftSample_8Bit + (int16_t)RightSample_8Bit) >> 1);
+
+ /* Load the sample into the PWM timer channel */
+ OCRxA = ((uint8_t)MixedSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7));
+#elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_STEREO)
+ /* Load the dual 8-bit samples into the PWM timer channels */
+ OCRxA = ((uint8_t)LeftSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7));
+ OCRxB = ((uint8_t)RightSample_8Bit ^ (1 << 7));
+#elif defined(AUDIO_OUT_PORTC)
+ /* Mix the two channels together to produce a mono, 8-bit sample */
+ int8_t MixedSample_8Bit = (((int16_t)LeftSample_8Bit + (int16_t)RightSample_8Bit) >> 1);
+
+ PORTC = MixedSample_8Bit;
+#else
+ uint8_t LEDMask = LEDS_NO_LEDS;
+
+ /* Make left channel positive (absolute) */
+ if (LeftSample_8Bit < 0)
+ LeftSample_8Bit = -LeftSample_8Bit;
+
+ /* Make right channel positive (absolute) */
+ if (RightSample_8Bit < 0)
+ RightSample_8Bit = -RightSample_8Bit;
+
+ /* Set first LED based on sample value */
+ if (LeftSample_8Bit < ((128 / 8) * 1))
+ LEDMask |= LEDS_LED2;
+ else if (LeftSample_8Bit < ((128 / 8) * 3))
+ LEDMask |= (LEDS_LED1 | LEDS_LED2);
+ else
+ LEDMask |= LEDS_LED1;
+
+ /* Set second LED based on sample value */
+ if (RightSample_8Bit < ((128 / 8) * 1))
+ LEDMask |= LEDS_LED4;
+ else if (RightSample_8Bit < ((128 / 8) * 3))
+ LEDMask |= (LEDS_LED3 | LEDS_LED4);
+ else
+ LEDMask |= LEDS_LED3;
+
+ LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMask);
+#endif
+ }
+}
diff --git a/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3b992317
--- /dev/null
+++ b/digital/avr/modules/usb/lufa/Demos/AudioOutput/AudioOutput.h
@@ -0,0 +1,127 @@
+/*
+ LUFA Library
+ Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2009.
+
+ dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com
+ www.fourwalledcubicle.com
+*/
+